Surgical anvil manufacturing methods

ABSTRACT

A method for manufacturing a surgical stapling anvil is disclosed. The method comprises the steps of manufacturing a first anvil member and a second anvil member. The first anvil member comprises a tissue-facing surface comprising a plurality of staple forming pockets defined therein and a longitudinal cavity comprising anvil ledges configured to be engaged by anvil-camming portions of a firing member of a surgical stapling instrument. The method further comprises the steps of polishing the ledges of the first anvil member and welding the first anvil member and the second anvil member together.

CROSS REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATION

This application is a continuation application claiming priority under 35 U.S.C. § 120 to U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/634,024, entitled SURGICAL ANVIL MANUFACTURING METHODS, filed on Jun. 27, 2017, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2018/0368839, the entire disclosure of which is hereby incorporated by reference herein.

BACKGROUND

The present invention relates to surgical instruments and, in various arrangements, to surgical stapling and cutting instruments and staple cartridges for use therewith that are designed to staple and cut tissue.

BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS

Various features of the embodiments described herein, together with advantages thereof, may be understood in accordance with the following description taken in conjunction with the accompanying drawings as follows:

FIG. 1 is a side elevational view of a surgical system comprising a handle assembly and multiple interchangeable surgical tool assemblies that may be used therewith;

FIG. 2 is a perspective view of one of the interchangeable surgical tool assemblies of FIG. 1 operably coupled to the handle assembly of FIG. 1 ;

FIG. 3 is an exploded assembly view of portions of the handle assembly and interchangeable surgical tool assembly of FIGS. 1 and 2 ;

FIG. 4 is a perspective view of another one of the interchangeable surgical tool assemblies depicted in FIG. 1 ;

FIG. 5 is a partial cross-sectional perspective view of the interchangeable surgical tool assembly of FIG. 4 ;

FIG. 6 is another partial cross-sectional view of a portion of the interchangeable surgical tool assembly of FIGS. 4 and 5 ;

FIG. 7 is an exploded assembly view of a portion of the interchangeable surgical tool assembly of FIGS. 4-6 ;

FIG. 7A is an enlarged top view of a portion of an elastic spine assembly of the interchangeable surgical tool assembly of FIG. 7 ;

FIG. 8 is an exploded assembly view of a portion of the interchangeable surgical tool assembly of FIGS. 4-7 ;

FIG. 9 is a cross-sectional perspective view of a surgical end effector portion of the interchangeable surgical tool assembly of FIGS. 4-8 ;

FIG. 10 is an exploded assembly view of the surgical end effector portion of the interchangeable surgical tool assembly depicted in FIG. 9 ;

FIG. 11 is a perspective view, a side elevational view and a front elevational view of a firing member that may be employed in the interchangeable surgical tool assembly of FIGS. 4-10 ;

FIG. 12 is a perspective view of an anvil that may be employed in the interchangeable surgical tool assembly of FIGS. 4-11 ;

FIG. 13 is a cross-sectional side elevational view of the anvil of FIG. 12 ;

FIG. 14 is a bottom view of the anvil of FIGS. 12 and 13 ;

FIG. 15 is a cross-sectional side elevational view of a portion of a surgical end effector and shaft portion of the interchangeable surgical tool assembly of FIG. 4 with an unspent surgical staple cartridge properly seated within an elongate channel of the surgical end effector;

FIG. 16 is a cross-sectional side elevational view of the surgical end effector and shaft portion of FIG. 15 after the surgical staple cartridge has been fired during a staple firing stroke and a firing member being retracted to a starting position after the staple firing stroke;

FIG. 17 is another cross-sectional side elevational view of the surgical end effector and shaft portion of FIG. 16 after the firing member has been fully retracted back to its starting position;

FIG. 18 is a top cross-sectional view of the surgical end effector and shaft portion depicted in FIG. 15 with the unspent surgical staple cartridge properly seated with the elongate channel of the surgical end effector;

FIG. 19 is another top cross-sectional view of the surgical end effector of FIG. 15 with a fired surgical staple cartridge mounted therein illustrating the firing member retained in a locked position;

FIG. 20 is a partial cross-sectional view of portions of the anvil and elongate channel of the interchangeable tool assembly of FIG. 4 ;

FIG. 21 is an exploded side elevational view of portions of the anvil and elongate channel of FIG. 20 ;

FIG. 22 is a rear perspective view of an anvil mounting portion of an anvil in accordance with at least one embodiment;

FIG. 23 is a rear perspective view of an anvil mounting portion of another anvil in accordance with at least one embodiment;

FIG. 24 is a rear perspective view of an anvil mounting portion of another anvil in accordance with at least one embodiment;

FIG. 25 is a perspective view of an anvil in accordance with at least one embodiment;

FIG. 26 is an exploded perspective view of the anvil of FIG. 25 ;

FIG. 27 is a cross-sectional end view of the anvil of FIG. 25 ;

FIG. 28 is a perspective view of another anvil in accordance with at least one embodiment;

FIG. 29 is an exploded perspective view of the anvil embodiment of FIG. 28 ;

FIG. 30 is a top view of a distal end portion of an anvil body portion of the anvil of FIG. 28 ;

FIG. 31 is a top view of a distal end portion of an anvil body portion of another anvil in accordance with at least one embodiment;

FIG. 32 is a cross-sectional end perspective view of the anvil of FIG. 31 ;

FIG. 33 is a cross-sectional end perspective view of another anvil in accordance with at least one embodiment;

FIG. 34 provides a comparison between a first embodiment of an anvil and a second embodiment of an anvil;

FIG. 35 is a cross-sectional view of an end effector comprising the second anvil embodiment of FIG. 34 ;

FIG. 36 is a partial cross-sectional view of the first anvil embodiment of FIG. 34 and a firing member configured to engage the first anvil embodiment;

FIG. 37 is a partial elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 36 ;

FIG. 38 is an illustration depicting stress concentrations in the first anvil embodiment of FIG. 34 and the firing member of FIG. 36 ;

FIG. 39 is an another illustration depicting stress concentrations in the firing member of FIG. 36 ;

FIG. 40 is a perspective view of a firing member in accordance with at least one embodiment;

FIG. 41 is a side elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 40 ;

FIG. 42 is a front elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 40 ;

FIG. 43 is a partial perspective view of a firing member in accordance with at least one embodiment;

FIG. 44 is a partial side elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 43 ;

FIG. 45 is a partial front elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 43 ;

FIG. 46 is a partial perspective view of a firing member in accordance with at least one embodiment;

FIG. 47 is a partial side elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 46 ;

FIG. 48 is a partial front elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 46 ;

FIG. 49 is a partial perspective view of a firing member in accordance with at least one embodiment;

FIG. 50 is a partial side elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 49 ;

FIG. 51 is a partial front elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 49 ;

FIG. 52 is a partial perspective view of a firing member in accordance with at least one embodiment;

FIG. 53 is a partial side elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 52 ;

FIG. 54 is a partial front elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 52 ;

FIG. 55 is a partial perspective view of a firing member in accordance with at least one embodiment;

FIG. 56 is a partial side elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 55 ;

FIG. 57 is a partial front elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 55 ;

FIG. 58 is a partial perspective view of a firing member in accordance with at least one embodiment;

FIG. 59 is a partial side elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 58 ;

FIG. 60 is a partial front elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 58 ;

FIG. 61 is a partial perspective view of a firing member in accordance with at least one embodiment;

FIG. 62 is a partial side elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 61 ;

FIG. 63 is a partial front elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 61 ;

FIG. 64 is a partial perspective view of a firing member in accordance with at least one embodiment;

FIG. 65 is a partial side elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 64 ;

FIG. 66 is another partial perspective view of the firing member of FIG. 64 ;

FIG. 67 is a partial front elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 64 ;

FIG. 68 is a schematic depicting the energy needed to advance firing members disclosed herein through staple firing strokes;

FIG. 69 is a detail view of a lateral projection extending from the firing member of FIG. 43 schematically illustrating the interaction between the lateral projection and an anvil in a flexed condition;

FIG. 70 is a detail view of a lateral projection extending from the firing member of FIG. 58 schematically illustrating the interaction between the lateral projection and an anvil in a flexed condition;

FIG. 71 is a detail view of a lateral projection extending from the firing member of FIG. 58 schematically illustrating the interaction between the lateral projection and an anvil another flexed condition;

FIG. 72 is a perspective view of an anvil of a surgical stapling instrument comprising an anvil body and an anvil cap;

FIG. 73 is an exploded view of the anvil of FIG. 72 ;

FIG. 74 is a partial, cross-sectional view of a welded, anvil comprising vertical welding surfaces;

FIG. 75 is a partial, cross-sectional view of a welded, anvil comprising horizontal welding surfaces;

FIG. 76 is a partial, cross-sectional view of a welded, anvil comprising angular welding surfaces;

FIG. 77 is a cross-sectional view an anvil comprising an anvil body and an anvil cap, wherein the anvil body and the anvil cap are welded to each other;

FIG. 78 is a micrograph of a surgical stapling anvil comprising a first anvil member and a second anvil member, wherein the first anvil member and the second anvil member are welded to each other;

FIG. 79 is a cross-sectional view of a surgical stapling anvil comprising an anvil body and an anvil cap;

FIG. 80 is a chart representing four different surgical stapling anvil arrangements subject to two different load scenarios comprising deflection and stress data for a first scenario and stress data for a second scenario;

FIG. 81 is a perspective view of an anvil comprising a first anvil member and a second anvil member, wherein the anvil members comprise a weld configuration configured to increase overall weld depth;

FIG. 82 is a cross-sectional view of the surgical stapling anvil of FIG. 81 prior to welding taken along line 82-82 in FIG. 81 ;

FIG. 83 is a cross-sectional view of the surgical stapling anvil of FIG. 81 after welding taken along line 83-83 in FIG. 81 ;

FIG. 84 is a cross-sectional view of a surgical stapling anvil comprising a first anvil member and a second anvil member welded to each other;

FIG. 85 is a partial cross-sectional, partially exploded view of the surgical stapling anvil of FIG. 84 ;

FIG. 86 is a cross-sectional view of a surgical stapling anvil comprising a first anvil member and a second anvil member welded to each other, wherein the anvil members comprise interlocking features;

FIG. 87 is a cross-sectional view of a surgical stapling anvil comprising a first anvil member and a second anvil member welded to each other, wherein the anvil members comprise interlocking features;

FIG. 88 is a perspective view of an end effector assembly illustrated in an open configuration;

FIG. 89 is a perspective view of the end effector assembly of FIG. 88 illustrated in a closed configuration;

FIG. 90 is a partial cross-sectional view of the end effector assembly of FIG. 88 taken along line 90-90 in FIG. 88 ;

FIG. 91 is a partial cross-sectional view of the end effector assembly of FIG. 88 taken along line 91-91 in FIG. 89 ;

FIG. 92 is a cross-sectional view of the end effector assembly of FIG. 88 taken along line 92-92 in FIG. 89 ;

FIG. 93 is a perspective view of a staple cartridge channel comprising a channel body and a channel cap welded thereto;

FIG. 94 is an exploded view of the staple cartridge channel of FIG. 93 ;

FIG. 95 is a cross-sectional view of a staple cartridge channel comprising a first channel member and a second channel member welded to each other;

FIG. 96 is a perspective view of a firing member for use with a surgical instrument, wherein the firing member comprises a first jaw-coupling member and a second jaw-coupling member;

FIG. 97 is a perspective view of another firing member for use with a surgical instrument, wherein the firing member comprises a first jaw-coupling member and a second jaw-coupling member;

FIG. 98 is a front view of the firing member of FIG. 96 ;

FIG. 99 is an elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 96 ;

FIG. 100 is a front view of the firing member of FIG. 97 ;

FIG. 101 is an elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 97 ;

FIG. 102 is a partial elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 96 ;

FIG. 103 is a partial elevational view of the firing member of FIG. 97 ;

FIG. 104 is a cross-sectional view of a stapling system comprising the firing member of FIG. 97 ;

FIG. 105 is a cross-sectional view of a stapling system comprising the firing member of FIG. 96 ;

FIG. 106 is a partial cross-sectional view of an anvil and the firing member of the stapling system of FIG. 105 ;

FIG. 107 is a partial cross-sectional view of an anvil and the firing member of the stapling system of FIG. 104 ;

FIG. 108 is a stress analysis of the anvil of the stapling system of FIG. 105 ;

FIG. 109 is a cross-sectional perspective view of a staple forming pocket arrangement comprising a proximal forming pocket and a distal forming pocket, wherein each forming pocket comprises a forming surface having an entry zone and an exit zone comprising different radii of curvature;

FIG. 110 is a plan view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 109 ;

FIG. 111 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 109 taken along line 111-111 in FIG. 110 ;

FIG. 112 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 109 taken along line 112-112 in FIG. 110 ;

FIG. 113 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 109 taken along line 113-113 in FIG. 110 ;

FIG. 114 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 109 taken along line 114-114 in FIG. 110 ;

FIG. 115 is a cross-sectional perspective view of a staple forming pocket arrangement comprising a proximal forming pocket, a distal forming pocket, and primary sidewalls, wherein each forming pocket comprises a pair of contoured sidewalls;

FIG. 116 is a plan view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 115 ;

FIG. 117 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 115 taken along line 117-117 in FIG. 116 ;

FIG. 118 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 115 taken along line 118-118 in FIG. 116 ;

FIG. 119 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 115 taken along line 119-119 in FIG. 116 ;

FIG. 120 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 115 taken along line 120-120 in FIG. 116 ;

FIG. 121 depicts a staple formed with the forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 115 in a fully formed configuration, wherein the staple contacted the forming pockets in an aligned state;

FIG. 122 depicts a staple formed with the forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 115 in a fully formed configuration, wherein the staple contacted the forming pockets in a misaligned state;

FIG. 123 is a cross-sectional perspective view of a staple forming pocket arrangement comprising a proximal forming pocket and a distal forming pocket;

FIG. 124 is a cross-sectional perspective view of a portion of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 123 ;

FIG. 125 is a plan view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 123 ;

FIG. 126 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 123 taken along line 126-126 in FIG. 125 ;

FIG. 127 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 123 taken along line 127-127 in the entry zone of the distal forming pocket of FIG. 125 ;

FIG. 128 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 123 taken along line 128-128 in the transition zone of the distal forming pocket in FIG. 125 ;

FIG. 129 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 123 taken along line 129-129 in the exit zone of the distal forming pocket of FIG. 125 ;

FIG. 129A is a partial negative view of a forming pocket of the staple forming pocket arrangements of FIG. 123 , wherein the partial negative view comprises various slices taken in multiple planes along the forming pocket which are perpendicular to a tissue-facing surface of the staple forming pocket arrangement and a pocket axis of the staple forming pocket arrangement;

FIG. 129B is a table comprising the dimensions of the slices of FIG. 129A which are labeled in FIG. 129A;

FIG. 129C is a cross-sectional view of the forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 123 taken along a pocket axis of the forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 123 , wherein various dimensions of the forming pocket arrangement are labeled thereon;

FIG. 130 is a cross-sectional perspective view of a staple forming pocket arrangement comprising a proximal forming pocket and a distal forming pocket;

FIG. 131 is a plan view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 130 ;

FIG. 132 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 130 taken along line 132-132 in FIG. 131 ;

FIG. 133 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 130 taken along line 133-133 in the entry zone of the distal forming pocket of FIG. 131 ;

FIG. 134 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 130 taken along line 134-134 in the transition zone of the distal forming pocket of FIG. 131 ;

FIG. 135 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 130 taken along line 135-135 in the exit forming zone of the distal forming pocket of FIG. 131 ;

FIG. 135A is a partial negative view of a forming pocket of the staple forming pocket arrangements of FIG. 130 , wherein the partial negative view comprises various slices taken in multiple planes along the forming pocket which are perpendicular to a tissue-facing surface of the staple forming pocket arrangement and a pocket axis of the staple forming pocket arrangement;

FIG. 135B is a table comprising the dimensions of the slices of FIG. 135A which are labeled in FIG. 135A;

FIG. 135C is a cross-sectional view of the forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 130 taken along a pocket axis of the forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 130 , wherein various dimensions of the forming pocket arrangement are labeled thereon;

FIG. 136 is a cross-sectional perspective view of a staple forming pocket arrangement comprising a proximal forming pocket and a distal forming pocket;

FIG. 137 is a plan view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 136 ;

FIG. 138 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 136 taken along line 138-138 in FIG. 137 ;

FIG. 139 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 136 taken along line 139-139 in the entry forming zone of the distal forming pocket of FIG. 137 ;

FIG. 140 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 136 taken along line 140-140 in the entry forming zone of the distal forming pocket of FIG. 137 ;

FIG. 141 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 136 taken along line 141-141 in the transition zone of the distal forming pocket of FIG. 137 ;

FIG. 142 is a cross-sectional view of the staple forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 136 taken along line 142-142 in the exit forming zone of the distal forming pocket of FIG. 137 ;

FIG. 142A is a partial negative view of a forming pocket of the staple forming pocket arrangements of FIG. 136 , wherein the partial negative view comprises various slices taken in multiple planes along the forming pocket which are perpendicular to a tissue-facing surface of the staple forming pocket arrangement and a pocket axis of the staple forming pocket arrangement;

FIG. 142B is a table comprising the dimensions of the slices of FIG. 142A which are labeled in FIG. 142A;

FIG. 142C is a cross-sectional view of the forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 136 taken along a pocket axis of the forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 136 , wherein various dimensions of the forming pocket arrangement are labeled thereon;

FIG. 143 is a plan view of a staple formed with the forming pocket arrangement of FIG. 130 in a fully formed configuration, wherein the staple contacted the forming pockets in a misaligned state;

FIG. 144 is an elevation view of the staple of FIG. 143 ;

FIG. 145 is a cross-sectional elevation view of a surgical end effector with various components removed depicting an anvil and a staple cartridge having a plurality of staples, further depicting the end effector in a closed position in which a uniform tissue gap is defined between the staple cartridge and the anvil, and further depicting the staples fired from the staple cartridge and formed to a uniform height by forming pockets in the anvil;

FIG. 146 is a cross-sectional elevation view of a surgical end effector with various components removed depicting an anvil and a staple cartridge having a plurality of staples, wherein the anvil comprises a stepped tissue compression surface, further depicting the end effector in a closed position in which a variable tissue gap is defined between the staple cartridge and the anvil, and further depicting the staples fired from the staple cartridge and formed to a uniform height by forming pockets in the anvil;

FIG. 147 is a cross-sectional elevation view of a surgical end effector with various components removed depicting an anvil and a staple cartridge having a plurality of staples and a stepped tissue compression surface, further depicting the end effector in a closed position in which a variable tissue gap is defined between the staple cartridge and the anvil, and further depicting the staples fired from the staple cartridge and formed to a uniform height by forming pockets in the anvil;

FIG. 148 is a cross-sectional elevation view of a surgical end effector with various components removed depicting an anvil and a staple cartridge having a plurality of staples, wherein the anvil and the staple cartridge comprise stepped tissue compression surfaces, further depicting the end effector in a closed position in which a variable tissue gap is defined between the staple cartridge and the anvil, and further depicting the staples fired from the staple cartridge and formed to a uniform height by forming pockets in the anvil;

FIG. 149 is a partial cross-sectional perspective view of an articulation joint for a surgical tool assembly with various components removed depicting the articulation joint in an unarticulated position;

FIG. 150 is a partial cross-sectional plan view of the articulation joint of FIG. 149 in the unarticulated configuration;

FIG. 151 is a partial cross-sectional plan view of the articulation joint of FIG. 149 in a partially articulated configuration;

FIG. 152 is a partial cross-sectional plan view of the articulation joint of FIG. 149 in a fully articulated configuration; and

FIG. 152A is a detail view of a reinforcement feature of the articulation joint of FIG. 149 in the fully articulated configuration of FIG. 152 .

Corresponding reference characters indicate corresponding parts throughout the several views. The exemplifications set out herein illustrate various embodiments of the invention, in one form, and such exemplifications are not to be construed as limiting the scope of the invention in any manner.

DETAILED DESCRIPTION

Applicant of the present application owns the following U.S. patent applications that were filed on Jun. 27, 2017 and which are each herein incorporated by reference in their respective entireties:

-   -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/634,035, entitled SURGICAL         ANVIL ARRANGEMENTS; now U.S. Patent Application Publication No.         2018/0368840;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/634,046, entitled SURGICAL         ANVIL ARRANGEMENTS; now U.S. Patent Application Publication No.         2018/0368841;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/634,054, entitled SURGICAL         ANVIL ARRANGEMENTS; now U.S. Patent Application Publication No.         2018/0368842;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/634,068, entitled SURGICAL         FIRING MEMBER ARRANGEMENTS; now U.S. Patent Application         Publication No. 2018/0368843;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/634,076, entitled STAPLE         FORMING POCKET ARRANGEMENTS; now U.S. Patent Application         Publication No. 2018/0368844;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/634,090, entitled STAPLE         FORMING POCKET ARRANGEMENTS; now U.S. Patent Application         Publication No. 2018/0368845;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/634,099, entitled SURGICAL         END EFFECTORS AND ANVILS; now U.S. Patent Application         Publication No. 2018/0368846; and     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/634,117, entitled         ARTICULATION SYSTEMS FOR SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS; now U.S. Pat. No.         10,631,859.

Applicant of the present application owns the following U.S. patent applications that were filed on Dec. 21, 2016 and which are each herein incorporated by reference in their respective entireties:

-   -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/386,185, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING INSTRUMENTS AND REPLACEABLE TOOL ASSEMBLIES THEREOF;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/386,230, entitled         ARTICULATABLE SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENTS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/386,221, entitled LOCKOUT         ARRANGEMENTS FOR SURGICAL END EFFECTORS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/386,209, entitled SURGICAL         END EFFECTORS AND FIRING MEMBERS THEREOF;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/386,198, entitled LOCKOUT         ARRANGEMENTS FOR SURGICAL END EFFECTORS AND REPLACEABLE TOOL         ASSEMBLIES;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/386,240, entitled SURGICAL         END EFFECTORS AND ADAPTABLE FIRING MEMBERS THEREFOR;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,939, entitled STAPLE         CARTRIDGES AND ARRANGEMENTS OF STAPLES AND STAPLE CAVITIES         THEREIN;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,941, entitled SURGICAL         TOOL ASSEMBLIES WITH CLUTCHING ARRANGEMENTS FOR SHIFTING BETWEEN         CLOSURE SYSTEMS WITH CLOSURE STROKE REDUCTION FEATURES AND         ARTICULATION AND FIRING SYSTEMS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,943, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING INSTRUMENTS AND STAPLE-FORMING ANVILS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,950, entitled SURGICAL         TOOL ASSEMBLIES WITH CLOSURE STROKE REDUCTION FEATURES;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,945, entitled STAPLE         CARTRIDGES AND ARRANGEMENTS OF STAPLES AND STAPLE CAVITIES         THEREIN;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,946, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING INSTRUMENTS AND STAPLE-FORMING ANVILS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,951, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS WITH JAW OPENING FEATURES FOR INCREASING A JAW         OPENING DISTANCE;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,953, entitled METHODS OF         STAPLING TISSUE;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,954, entitled FIRING         MEMBERS WITH NON-PARALLEL JAW ENGAGEMENT FEATURES FOR SURGICAL         END EFFECTORS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,955, entitled SURGICAL         END EFFECTORS WITH EXPANDABLE TISSUE STOP ARRANGEMENTS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,948, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING INSTRUMENTS AND STAPLE-FORMING ANVILS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,956, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS WITH POSITIVE JAW OPENING FEATURES;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,958, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS WITH LOCKOUT ARRANGEMENTS FOR PREVENTING FIRING         SYSTEM ACTUATION UNLESS AN UNSPENT STAPLE CARTRIDGE IS PRESENT;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,947, entitled STAPLE         CARTRIDGES AND ARRANGEMENTS OF STAPLES AND STAPLE CAVITIES         THEREIN;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,896, entitled METHOD FOR         RESETTING A FUSE OF A SURGICAL INSTRUMENT SHAFT;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,898, entitled STAPLE         FORMING POCKET ARRANGEMENT TO ACCOMMODATE DIFFERENT TYPES OF         STAPLES;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,899, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT COMPRISING IMPROVED JAW CONTROL;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,901, entitled STAPLE         CARTRIDGE AND STAPLE CARTRIDGE CHANNEL COMPRISING WINDOWS         DEFINED THEREIN;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,902, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT COMPRISING A CUTTING MEMBER;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,904, entitled STAPLE         FIRING MEMBER COMPRISING A MISSING CARTRIDGE AND/OR SPENT         CARTRIDGE LOCKOUT;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,905, entitled FIRING         ASSEMBLY COMPRISING A LOCKOUT;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,907, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT SYSTEM COMPRISING AN END EFFECTOR LOCKOUT AND A         FIRING ASSEMBLY LOCKOUT;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,908, entitled FIRING         ASSEMBLY COMPRISING A FUSE;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,909, entitled FIRING         ASSEMBLY COMPRISING A MULTIPLE FAILED-STATE FUSE;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,920, entitled STAPLE         FORMING POCKET ARRANGEMENTS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,913, entitled ANVIL         ARRANGEMENTS FOR SURGICAL STAPLE/FASTENERS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,914, entitled METHOD OF         DEFORMING STAPLES FROM TWO DIFFERENT TYPES OF STAPLE CARTRIDGES         WITH THE SAME SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENT;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,893, entitled         BILATERALLY ASYMMETRIC STAPLE FORMING POCKET PAIRS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,929, entitled CLOSURE         MEMBERS WITH CAM SURFACE ARRANGEMENTS FOR SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS         WITH SEPARATE AND DISTINCT CLOSURE AND FIRING SYSTEMS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,911, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLE/FASTENERS WITH INDEPENDENTLY ACTUATABLE CLOSING AND         FIRING SYSTEMS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,927, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING INSTRUMENTS WITH SMART STAPLE CARTRIDGES;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,917, entitled STAPLE         CARTRIDGE COMPRISING STAPLES WITH DIFFERENT CLAMPING BREADTHS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,900, entitled STAPLE         FORMING POCKET ARRANGEMENTS COMPRISING PRIMARY SIDEWALLS AND         POCKET SIDEWALLS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,931, entitled         NO-CARTRIDGE AND SPENT CARTRIDGE LOCKOUT ARRANGEMENTS FOR         SURGICAL STAPLE/FASTENERS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,915, entitled FIRING         MEMBER PIN ANGLE;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,897, entitled STAPLE         FORMING POCKET ARRANGEMENTS COMPRISING ZONED FORMING SURFACE         GROOVES;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,922, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT WITH MULTIPLE FAILURE RESPONSE MODES;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,924, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT WITH PRIMARY AND SAFETY PROCESSORS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,912, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS WITH JAWS THAT ARE PIVOTABLE ABOUT A FIXED AXIS AND         INCLUDE SEPARATE AND DISTINCT CLOSURE AND FIRING SYSTEMS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,910, entitled ANVIL         HAVING A KNIFE SLOT WIDTH;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,906, entitled FIRING         MEMBER PIN CONFIGURATIONS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/386,188, entitled STEPPED         STAPLE CARTRIDGE WITH ASYMMETRICAL STAPLES;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/386,192, entitled STEPPED         STAPLE CARTRIDGE WITH TISSUE RETENTION AND GAP SETTING FEATURES;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/386,206, entitled STAPLE         CARTRIDGE WITH DEFORMABLE DRIVER RETENTION FEATURES;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/386,226, entitled DURABILITY         FEATURES FOR END EFFECTORS AND FIRING ASSEMBLIES OF SURGICAL         STAPLING INSTRUMENTS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/386,222, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING INSTRUMENTS HAVING END EFFECTORS WITH POSITIVE OPENING         FEATURES;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/386,236, entitled CONNECTION         PORTIONS FOR DEPOSABLE LOADING UNITS FOR SURGICAL STAPLING         INSTRUMENTS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,887, entitled METHOD FOR         ATTACHING A SHAFT ASSEMBLY TO A SURGICAL INSTRUMENT AND,         ALTERNATIVELY, TO A SURGICAL ROBOT;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,889, entitled SHAFT         ASSEMBLY COMPRISING A MANUALLY-OPERABLE RETRACTION SYSTEM FOR         USE WITH A MOTORIZED SURGICAL INSTRUMENT SYSTEM;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,890, entitled SHAFT         ASSEMBLY COMPRISING SEPARATELY ACTUATABLE AND RETRACTABLE         SYSTEMS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,891, entitled SHAFT         ASSEMBLY COMPRISING A CLUTCH CONFIGURED TO ADAPT THE OUTPUT OF A         ROTARY FIRING MEMBER TO TWO DIFFERENT SYSTEMS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,892, entitled SURGICAL         SYSTEM COMPRISING A FIRING MEMBER ROTATABLE INTO AN ARTICULATION         STATE TO ARTICULATE AN END EFFECTOR OF THE SURGICAL SYSTEM;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,894, entitled SHAFT         ASSEMBLY COMPRISING A LOCKOUT;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,895, entitled SHAFT         ASSEMBLY COMPRISING FIRST AND SECOND ARTICULATION LOCKOUTS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,916, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING SYSTEMS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,918, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING SYSTEMS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,919, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING SYSTEMS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,921, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLE/FASTENER CARTRIDGE WITH MOVABLE CAMMING MEMBER CONFIGURED         TO DISENGAGE FIRING MEMBER LOCKOUT FEATURES;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,923, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING SYSTEMS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,925, entitled JAW         ACTUATED LOCK ARRANGEMENTS FOR PREVENTING ADVANCEMENT OF A         FIRING MEMBER IN A SURGICAL END EFFECTOR UNLESS AN UNFIRED         CARTRIDGE IS INSTALLED IN THE END EFFECTOR;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,926, entitled AXIALLY         MOVABLE CLOSURE SYSTEM ARRANGEMENTS FOR APPLYING CLOSURE MOTIONS         TO JAWS OF SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,928, entitled PROTECTIVE         COVER ARRANGEMENTS FOR A JOINT INTERFACE BETWEEN A MOVABLE JAW         AND ACTUATOR SHAFT OF A SURGICAL INSTRUMENT;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,930, entitled SURGICAL         END EFFECTOR WITH TWO SEPARATE COOPERATING OPENING FEATURES FOR         OPENING AND CLOSING END EFFECTOR JAWS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,932, entitled         ARTICULATABLE SURGICAL END EFFECTOR WITH ASYMMETRIC SHAFT         ARRANGEMENT;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,933, entitled         ARTICULATABLE SURGICAL INSTRUMENT WITH INDEPENDENT PIVOTABLE         LINKAGE DISTAL OF AN ARTICULATION LOCK;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,934, entitled         ARTICULATION LOCK ARRANGEMENTS FOR LOCKING AN END EFFECTOR IN AN         ARTICULATED POSITION IN RESPONSE TO ACTUATION OF A JAW CLOSURE         SYSTEM;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,935, entitled LATERALLY         ACTUATABLE ARTICULATION LOCK ARRANGEMENTS FOR LOCKING AN END         EFFECTOR OF A SURGICAL INSTRUMENT IN AN ARTICULATED         CONFIGURATION; and     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,936, entitled         ARTICULATABLE SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS WITH ARTICULATION STROKE         AMPLIFICATION FEATURES.

Applicant of the present application owns the following U.S. patent applications that were filed on Jun. 24, 2016 and which are each herein incorporated by reference in their respective entireties:

-   -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/191,775, entitled STAPLE         CARTRIDGE COMPRISING WIRE STAPLES AND STAMPED STAPLES;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/191,807, entitled STAPLING         SYSTEM FOR USE WITH WIRE STAPLES AND STAMPED STAPLES;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/191,834, entitled STAMPED         STAPLES AND STAPLE CARTRIDGES USING THE SAME;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/191,788, entitled STAPLE         CARTRIDGE COMPRISING OVERDRIVEN STAPLES; and     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/191,818, entitled STAPLE         CARTRIDGE COMPRISING OFFSET LONGITUDINAL STAPLE ROWS.

Applicant of the present application owns the following U.S. patent applications that were filed on Jun. 24, 2016 and which are each herein incorporated by reference in their respective entireties:

U.S. Design patent application Ser. No. 29/569,218, entitled SURGICAL FASTENER;

-   -   U.S. Design patent application Ser. No. 29/569,227, entitled         SURGICAL FASTENER;     -   U.S. Design patent application Ser. No. 29/569,259, entitled         SURGICAL FASTENER CARTRIDGE; and     -   U.S. Design patent application Ser. No. 29/569,264, entitled         SURGICAL FASTENER CARTRIDGE.

Applicant of the present application owns the following patent applications that were filed on Apr. 1, 2016 and which are each herein incorporated by reference in their respective entirety:

-   -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,325, entitled METHOD FOR         OPERATING A SURGICAL STAPLING SYSTEM;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,321, entitled MODULAR         SURGICAL STAPLING SYSTEM COMPRISING A DISPLAY;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,326, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING SYSTEM COMPRISING A DISPLAY INCLUDING A RE-ORIENTABLE         DISPLAY FIELD;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,263, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT HANDLE ASSEMBLY WITH RECONFIGURABLE GRIP PORTION;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,262, entitled ROTARY         POWERED SURGICAL INSTRUMENT WITH MANUALLY ACTUATABLE BAILOUT         SYSTEM;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,277, entitled SURGICAL         CUTTING AND STAPLING END EFFECTOR WITH ANVIL CONCENTRIC DRIVE         MEMBER;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,296, entitled         INTERCHANGEABLE SURGICAL TOOL ASSEMBLY WITH A SURGICAL END         EFFECTOR THAT IS SELECTIVELY ROTATABLE ABOUT A SHAFT AXIS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,258, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING SYSTEM COMPRISING A SHIFTABLE TRANSMISSION;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,278, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING SYSTEM CONFIGURED TO PROVIDE SELECTIVE CUTTING OF         TISSUE;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,284, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING SYSTEM COMPRISING A CONTOURABLE SHAFT;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,295, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING SYSTEM COMPRISING A TISSUE COMPRESSION LOCKOUT;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,300, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING SYSTEM COMPRISING AN UNCLAMPING LOCKOUT;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,196, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING SYSTEM COMPRISING A JAW CLOSURE LOCKOUT;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,203, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING SYSTEM COMPRISING A JAW ATTACHMENT LOCKOUT;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,210, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING SYSTEM COMPRISING A SPENT CARTRIDGE LOCKOUT;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,324, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT COMPRISING A SHIFTING MECHANISM;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,335, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING INSTRUMENT COMPRISING MULTIPLE LOCKOUTS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,339, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING INSTRUMENT;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,253, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING SYSTEM CONFIGURED TO APPLY ANNULAR ROWS OF STAPLES         HAVING DIFFERENT HEIGHTS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,304, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING SYSTEM COMPRISING A GROOVED FORMING POCKET;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,331, entitled ANVIL         MODIFICATION MEMBERS FOR SURGICAL STAPLE/FASTENERS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,336, entitled STAPLE         CARTRIDGES WITH ATRAUMATIC FEATURES;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,312, entitled CIRCULAR         STAPLING SYSTEM COMPRISING AN INCISABLE TISSUE SUPPORT;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,309, entitled CIRCULAR         STAPLING SYSTEM COMPRISING ROTARY FIRING SYSTEM; and     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/089,349, entitled CIRCULAR         STAPLING SYSTEM COMPRISING LOAD CONTROL.

Applicant of the present application also owns the U.S. patent applications identified below which were filed on Dec. 31, 2015 which are each herein incorporated by reference in their respective entirety:

-   -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/984,488, entitled MECHANISMS         FOR COMPENSATING FOR BATTERY PACK FAILURE IN POWERED SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/984,525, entitled MECHANISMS         FOR COMPENSATING FOR DRIVETRAIN FAILURE IN POWERED SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS; and     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/984,552, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS WITH SEPARABLE MOTORS AND MOTOR CONTROL CIRCUITS.

Applicant of the present application also owns the U.S. patent applications identified below which were filed on Feb. 9, 2016 which are each herein incorporated by reference in their respective entirety:

-   -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/019,220, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT WITH ARTICULATING AND AXIALLY TRANSLATABLE END         EFFECTOR;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/019,228, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS WITH MULTIPLE LINK ARTICULATION ARRANGEMENTS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/019,196, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT ARTICULATION MECHANISM WITH SLOTTED SECONDARY         CONSTRAINT;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/019,206, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS WITH AN END EFFECTOR THAT IS HIGHLY ARTICULATABLE         RELATIVE TO AN ELONGATE SHAFT ASSEMBLY;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/019,215, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS WITH NON-SYMMETRICAL ARTICULATION ARRANGEMENTS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/019,227, entitled         ARTICULATABLE SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS WITH SINGLE ARTICULATION LINK         ARRANGEMENTS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/019,235, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS WITH TENSIONING ARRANGEMENTS FOR CABLE DRIVEN         ARTICULATION SYSTEMS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/019,230, entitled         ARTICULATABLE SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS WITH OFF-AXIS FIRING BEAM         ARRANGEMENTS; and     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/019,245, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS WITH CLOSURE STROKE REDUCTION ARRANGEMENTS.

Applicant of the present application also owns the U.S. patent applications identified below which were filed on Feb. 12, 2016 which are each herein incorporated by reference in their respective entirety:

-   -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/043,254, entitled MECHANISMS         FOR COMPENSATING FOR DRIVETRAIN FAILURE IN POWERED SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/043,259, entitled MECHANISMS         FOR COMPENSATING FOR DRIVETRAIN FAILURE IN POWERED SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/043,275, entitled MECHANISMS         FOR COMPENSATING FOR DRIVETRAIN FAILURE IN POWERED SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS; and     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/043,289, entitled MECHANISMS         FOR COMPENSATING FOR DRIVETRAIN FAILURE IN POWERED SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS.

Applicant of the present application owns the following patent applications that were filed on Jun. 18, 2015 and which are each herein incorporated by reference in their respective entirety:

-   -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/742,925, entitled SURGICAL         END EFFECTORS WITH POSITIVE JAW OPENING ARRANGEMENTS, now U.S.         Patent Application Publication No. 2016/0367256;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/742,941, entitled SURGICAL         END EFFECTORS WITH DUAL CAM ACTUATED JAW CLOSING FEATURES, now         U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2016/0367248;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/742,914, entitled MOVABLE         FIRING BEAM SUPPORT ARRANGEMENTS FOR ARTICULATABLE SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No.         2016/0367255;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/742,900, entitled         ARTICULATABLE SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS WITH COMPOSITE FIRING BEAM         STRUCTURES WITH CENTER FIRING SUPPORT MEMBER FOR ARTICULATION         SUPPORT, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No.         2016/0367254;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/742,885, entitled DUAL         ARTICULATION DRIVE SYSTEM ARRANGEMENTS FOR ARTICULATABLE         SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS, now U.S. Patent Application Publication         No. 2016/0367246; and     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/742,876, entitled PUSH/PULL         ARTICULATION DRIVE SYSTEMS FOR ARTICULATABLE SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No.         2016/0367245.

Applicant of the present application owns the following patent applications that were filed on Mar. 6, 2015 and which are each herein incorporated by reference in their respective entirety:

-   -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/640,746, entitled POWERED         SURGICAL INSTRUMENT, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No.         2016/0256184;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/640,795, entitled MULTIPLE         LEVEL THRESHOLDS TO MODIFY OPERATION OF POWERED SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No.         2016/02561185;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/640,832, entitled ADAPTIVE         TISSUE COMPRESSION TECHNIQUES TO ADJUST CLOSURE RATES FOR         MULTIPLE TISSUE TYPES, now U.S. Patent Application Publication         No. 2016/0256154;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/640,935, entitled OVERLAID         MULTI SENSOR RADIO FREQUENCY (RF) ELECTRODE SYSTEM TO MEASURE         TISSUE COMPRESSION, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No.         2016/0256071;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/640,831, entitled MONITORING         SPEED CONTROL AND PRECISION INCREMENTING OF MOTOR FOR POWERED         SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS, now U.S. Patent Application Publication         No. 2016/0256153;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/640,859, entitled TIME         DEPENDENT EVALUATION OF SENSOR DATA TO DETERMINE STABILITY,         CREEP, AND VISCOELASTIC ELEMENTS OF MEASURES, now U.S. Patent         Application Publication No. 2016/0256187;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/640,817, entitled         INTERACTIVE FEEDBACK SYSTEM FOR POWERED SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS,         now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2016/0256186;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/640,844, entitled CONTROL         TECHNIQUES AND SUB-PROCESSOR CONTAINED WITHIN MODULAR SHAFT WITH         SELECT CONTROL PROCESSING FROM HANDLE, now U.S. Patent         Application Publication No. 2016/0256155;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/640,837, entitled SMART         SENSORS WITH LOCAL SIGNAL PROCESSING, now U.S. Patent         Application Publication No. 2016/0256163;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/640,765, entitled SYSTEM FOR         DETECTING THE MIS-INSERTION OF A STAPLE CARTRIDGE INTO A         SURGICAL STAPLE/FASTENER, now U.S. Patent Application         Publication No. 2016/0256160;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/640,799, entitled SIGNAL AND         POWER COMMUNICATION SYSTEM POSITIONED ON A ROTATABLE SHAFT, now         U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2016/0256162; and     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/640,780, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT COMPRISING A LOCKABLE BATTERY HOUSING, now U.S.         Patent Application Publication No. 2016/0256161.

Applicant of the present application owns the following patent applications that were filed on Feb. 27, 2015, and which are each herein incorporated by reference in their respective entirety:

-   -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/633,576, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT SYSTEM COMPRISING AN INSPECTION STATION, now U.S.         Patent Application Publication No. 2016/0249919;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/633,546, entitled SURGICAL         APPARATUS CONFIGURED TO ASSESS WHETHER A PERFORMANCE PARAMETER         OF THE SURGICAL APPARATUS IS WITHIN AN ACCEPTABLE PERFORMANCE         BAND, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2016/0249915;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/633,560, entitled SURGICAL         CHARGING SYSTEM THAT CHARGES AND/OR CONDITIONS ONE OR MORE         BATTERIES, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No.         2016/0249910;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/633,566, entitled CHARGING         SYSTEM THAT ENABLES EMERGENCY RESOLUTIONS FOR CHARGING A         BATTERY, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No.         2016/0249918;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/633,555, entitled SYSTEM FOR         MONITORING WHETHER A SURGICAL INSTRUMENT NEEDS TO BE SERVICED,         now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2016/0249916;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/633,542, entitled REINFORCED         BATTERY FOR A SURGICAL INSTRUMENT, now U.S. Patent Application         Publication No. 2016/0249908;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/633,548, entitled POWER         ADAPTER FOR A SURGICAL INSTRUMENT, now U.S. Patent Application         Publication No. 2016/0249909;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/633,526, entitled ADAPTABLE         SURGICAL INSTRUMENT HANDLE, now U.S. Patent Application         Publication No. 2016/0249945;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/633,541, entitled MODULAR         STAPLING ASSEMBLY, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No.         2016/0249927; and     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/633,562, entitled SURGICAL         APPARATUS CONFIGURED TO TRACK AN END-OF-LIFE PARAMETER, now U.S.         Patent Application Publication No. 2016/0249917.

Applicant of the present application owns the following patent applications that were filed on Dec. 18, 2014 and which are each herein incorporated by reference in their respective entirety:

-   -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/574,478, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT SYSTEMS COMPRISING AN ARTICULATABLE END EFFECTOR AND         MEANS FOR ADJUSTING THE FIRING STROKE OF A FIRING MEMBER, now         U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2016/0174977;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/574,483, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT ASSEMBLY COMPRISING LOCKABLE SYSTEMS, now U.S. Patent         Application Publication No. 2016/0174969;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/575,139, entitled DRIVE         ARRANGEMENTS FOR ARTICULATABLE SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS, now U.S.         Patent Application Publication No. 2016/0174978;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/575,148, entitled LOCKING         ARRANGEMENTS FOR DETACHABLE SHAFT ASSEMBLIES WITH ARTICULATABLE         SURGICAL END EFFECTORS, now U.S. Patent Application Publication         No. 2016/0174976;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/575,130, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT WITH AN ANVIL THAT IS SELECTIVELY MOVABLE ABOUT A         DISCRETE NON-MOVABLE AXIS RELATIVE TO A STAPLE CARTRIDGE, now         U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2016/0174972;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/575,143, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS WITH IMPROVED CLOSURE ARRANGEMENTS, now U.S. Patent         Application Publication No. 2016/0174983;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/575,117, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS WITH ARTICULATABLE END EFFECTORS AND MOVABLE FIRING         BEAM SUPPORT ARRANGEMENTS, now U.S. Patent Application         Publication No. 2016/0174975;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/575,154, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS WITH ARTICULATABLE END EFFECTORS AND IMPROVED FIRING         BEAM SUPPORT ARRANGEMENTS, now U.S. Patent Application         Publication No. 2016/0174973;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/574,493, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT ASSEMBLY COMPRISING A FLEXIBLE ARTICULATION SYSTEM,         now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2016/0174970; and     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/574,500, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT ASSEMBLY COMPRISING A LOCKABLE ARTICULATION SYSTEM,         now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2016/0174971.

Applicant of the present application owns the following patent applications that were filed on Mar. 1, 2013 and which are each herein incorporated by reference in their respective entirety:

-   -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/782,295, entitled         ARTICULATABLE SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS WITH CONDUCTIVE PATHWAYS FOR         SIGNAL COMMUNICATION, now U.S. Patent Application Publication         No. 2014/0246471;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/782,323, entitled ROTARY         POWERED ARTICULATION JOINTS FOR SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS, now U.S.         Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0246472;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/782,338, entitled THUMBWHEEL         SWITCH ARRANGEMENTS FOR SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS, now U.S. Patent         Application Publication No. 2014/0249557;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/782,499, entitled         ELECTROMECHANICAL SURGICAL DEVICE WITH SIGNAL RELAY ARRANGEMENT,         now U.S. Pat. No. 9,358,003;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/782,460, entitled MULTIPLE         PROCESSOR MOTOR CONTROL FOR MODULAR SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS, now         U.S. Pat. No. 9,554,794;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/782,358, entitled JOYSTICK         SWITCH ASSEMBLIES FOR SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS, now U.S. Pat. No.         9,326,767;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/782,481, entitled SENSOR         STRAIGHTENED END EFFECTOR DURING REMOVAL THROUGH TROCAR, now         U.S. Pat. No. 9,468,438;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/782,518, entitled CONTROL         METHODS FOR SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS WITH REMOVABLE IMPLEMENT         PORTIONS, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No.         2014/0246475;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/782,375, entitled ROTARY         POWERED SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS WITH MULTIPLE DEGREES OF FREEDOM,         now U.S. Pat. No. 9,398,911; and     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/782,536, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT SOFT STOP, now U.S. Pat. No. 9,307,986.

Applicant of the present application also owns the following patent applications that were filed on Mar. 14, 2013 and which are each herein incorporated by reference in their respective entirety:

-   -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/803,097, entitled         ARTICULATABLE SURGICAL INSTRUMENT COMPRISING A FIRING DRIVE, now         U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0263542;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/803,193, entitled CONTROL         ARRANGEMENTS FOR A DRIVE MEMBER OF A SURGICAL INSTRUMENT, now         U.S. Pat. No. 9,332,987;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/803,053, entitled         INTERCHANGEABLE SHAFT ASSEMBLIES FOR USE WITH A SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No.         2014/0263564;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/803,086, entitled         ARTICULATABLE SURGICAL INSTRUMENT COMPRISING AN ARTICULATION         LOCK, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0263541;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/803,210, entitled SENSOR         ARRANGEMENTS FOR ABSOLUTE POSITIONING SYSTEM FOR SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No.         2014/0263538;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/803,148, entitled         MULTI-FUNCTION MOTOR FOR A SURGICAL INSTRUMENT, now U.S. Patent         Application Publication No. 2014/0263554;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/803,066, entitled DRIVE         SYSTEM LOCKOUT ARRANGEMENTS FOR MODULAR SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS,         now U.S. Pat. No. 9,629,623;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/803,117, entitled         ARTICULATION CONTROL SYSTEM FOR ARTICULATABLE SURGICAL         INSTRUMENTS, now U.S. Pat. No. 9,351,726;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/803,130, entitled DRIVE         TRAIN CONTROL ARRANGEMENTS FOR MODULAR SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS, now         U.S. Pat. No. 9,351,727; and     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/803,159, entitled METHOD AND         SYSTEM FOR OPERATING A SURGICAL INSTRUMENT, now U.S. Patent         Application Publication No. 2014/0277017.

Applicant of the present application also owns the following patent application that was filed on Mar. 7, 2014 and is herein incorporated by reference in its entirety:

-   -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/200,111, entitled CONTROL         SYSTEMS FOR SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS, now U.S. Pat. No. 9,629,629.

Applicant of the present application also owns the following patent applications that were filed on Mar. 26, 2014 and are each herein incorporated by reference in their respective entirety:

-   -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/226,106, entitled POWER         MANAGEMENT CONTROL SYSTEMS FOR SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS, now U.S.         Patent Application Publication No. 2015/0272582;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/226,099, entitled         STERILIZATION VERIFICATION CIRCUIT, now U.S. Patent Application         Publication No. 2015/0272581;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/226,094, entitled         VERIFICATION OF NUMBER OF BATTERY EXCHANGES/PROCEDURE COUNT, now         U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2015/0272580;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/226,117, entitled POWER         MANAGEMENT THROUGH SLEEP OPTIONS OF SEGMENTED CIRCUIT AND WAKE         UP CONTROL, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No.         2015/0272574;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/226,075, entitled MODULAR         POWERED SURGICAL INSTRUMENT WITH DETACHABLE SHAFT ASSEMBLIES,         now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2015/0272579;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/226,093, entitled FEEDBACK         ALGORITHMS FOR MANUAL BAILOUT SYSTEMS FOR SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS,         now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2015/0272569;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/226,116, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT UTILIZING SENSOR ADAPTATION, now U.S. Patent         Application Publication No. 2015/0272571;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/226,071, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT CONTROL CIRCUIT HAVING A SAFETY PROCESSOR, now U.S.         Patent Application Publication No. 2015/0272578;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/226,097, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT COMPRISING INTERACTIVE SYSTEMS, now U.S. Patent         Application Publication No. 2015/0272570;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/226,126, entitled INTERFACE         SYSTEMS FOR USE WITH SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS, now U.S. Patent         Application Publication No. 2015/0272572;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/226,133, entitled MODULAR         SURGICAL INSTRUMENT SYSTEM, now U.S. Patent Application         Publication No. 2015/0272557;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/226,081, entitled SYSTEMS         AND METHODS FOR CONTROLLING A SEGMENTED CIRCUIT, now U.S. Patent         Application Publication No. 2015/0277471;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/226,076, entitled POWER         MANAGEMENT THROUGH SEGMENTED CIRCUIT AND VARIABLE VOLTAGE         PROTECTION, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No.         2015/0280424;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/226,111, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING INSTRUMENT SYSTEM, now U.S. Patent Application         Publication No. 2015/0272583; and     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/226,125, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT COMPRISING A ROTATABLE SHAFT, now U.S. Patent         Application Publication No. 2015/0280384.

Applicant of the present application also owns the following patent applications that were filed on Sep. 5, 2014 and which are each herein incorporated by reference in their respective entirety:

-   -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/479,103, entitled CIRCUITRY         AND SENSORS FOR POWERED MEDICAL DEVICE, now U.S. Patent         Application Publication No. 2016/0066912;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/479,119, entitled ADJUNCT         WITH INTEGRATED SENSORS TO QUANTIFY TISSUE COMPRESSION, now U.S.         Patent Application Publication No. 2016/0066914;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/478,908, entitled MONITORING         DEVICE DEGRADATION BASED ON COMPONENT EVALUATION, now U.S.         Patent Application Publication No. 2016/0066910;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/478,895, entitled MULTIPLE         SENSORS WITH ONE SENSOR AFFECTING A SECOND SENSOR'S OUTPUT OR         INTERPRETATION, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No.         2016/0066909;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/479,110, entitled POLARITY         OF HALL MAGNET TO DETECT MISLOADED CARTRIDGE, now U.S. Patent         Application Publication No. 2016/0066915;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/479,098, entitled SMART         CARTRIDGE WAKE UP OPERATION AND DATA RETENTION, now U.S. Patent         Application Publication No. 2016/0066911;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/479,115, entitled MULTIPLE         MOTOR CONTROL FOR POWERED MEDICAL DEVICE, now U.S. Patent         Application Publication No. 2016/0066916; and     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/479,108, entitled LOCAL         DISPLAY OF TISSUE PARAMETER STABILIZATION, now U.S. Patent         Application Publication No. 2016/0066913.

Applicant of the present application also owns the following patent applications that were filed on Apr. 9, 2014 and which are each herein incorporated by reference in their respective entirety:

-   -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/248,590, entitled MOTOR         DRIVEN SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS WITH LOCKABLE DUAL DRIVE SHAFTS, now         U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0305987;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/248,581, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT COMPRISING A CLOSING DRIVE AND A FIRING DRIVE         OPERATED FROM THE SAME ROTATABLE OUTPUT, now U.S. Pat. No.         9,649,110;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/248,595, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT SHAFT INCLUDING SWITCHES FOR CONTROLLING THE         OPERATION OF THE SURGICAL INSTRUMENT, now U.S. Patent         Application Publication No. 2014/0305988;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/248,588, entitled POWERED         LINEAR SURGICAL STAPLE/FASTENER, now U.S. Patent Application         Publication No. 2014/0309666;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/248,591, entitled         TRANSMISSION ARRANGEMENT FOR A SURGICAL INSTRUMENT, now U.S.         Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0305991;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/248,584, entitled MODULAR         MOTOR DRIVEN SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS WITH ALIGNMENT FEATURES FOR         ALIGNING ROTARY DRIVE SHAFTS WITH SURGICAL END EFFECTOR SHAFTS,         now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0305994;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/248,587, entitled POWERED         SURGICAL STAPLE/FASTENER, now U.S. Patent Application         Publication No. 2014/0309665;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/248,586, entitled DRIVE         SYSTEM DECOUPLING ARRANGEMENT FOR A SURGICAL INSTRUMENT, now         U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0305990; and     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/248,607, entitled MODULAR         MOTOR DRIVEN SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS WITH STATUS INDICATION         ARRANGEMENTS, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No.         2014/0305992.

Applicant of the present application also owns the following patent applications that were filed on Apr. 16, 2013 and which are each herein incorporated by reference in their respective entirety:

-   -   U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/812,365,         entitled SURGICAL INSTRUMENT WITH MULTIPLE FUNCTIONS PERFORMED         BY A SINGLE MOTOR;     -   U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/812,376,         entitled LINEAR CUTTER WITH POWER;     -   U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/812,382,         entitled LINEAR CUTTER WITH MOTOR AND PISTOL GRIP;     -   U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/812,385,         entitled SURGICAL INSTRUMENT HANDLE WITH MULTIPLE ACTUATION         MOTORS AND MOTOR CONTROL; and     -   U.S. Provisional Patent Application Ser. No. 61/812,372,         entitled SURGICAL INSTRUMENT WITH MULTIPLE FUNCTIONS PERFORMED         BY A SINGLE MOTOR.

Numerous specific details are set forth to provide a thorough understanding of the overall structure, function, manufacture, and use of the embodiments as described in the specification and illustrated in the accompanying drawings. Well-known operations, components, and elements have not been described in detail so as not to obscure the embodiments described in the specification. The reader will understand that the embodiments described and illustrated herein are non-limiting examples, and thus it can be appreciated that the specific structural and functional details disclosed herein may be representative and illustrative. Variations and changes thereto may be made without departing from the scope of the claims.

The terms “comprise” (and any form of comprise, such as “comprises” and “comprising”), “have” (and any form of have, such as “has” and “having”), “include” (and any form of include, such as “includes” and “including”) and “contain” (and any form of contain, such as “contains” and “containing”) are open-ended linking verbs. As a result, a surgical system, device, or apparatus that “comprises,” “has,” “includes” or “contains” one or more elements possesses those one or more elements, but is not limited to possessing only those one or more elements. Likewise, an element of a system, device, or apparatus that “comprises,” “has,” “includes” or “contains” one or more features possesses those one or more features, but is not limited to possessing only those one or more features.

The terms “proximal” and “distal” are used herein with reference to a clinician manipulating the handle portion of the surgical instrument. The term “proximal” refers to the portion closest to the clinician and the term “distal” refers to the portion located away from the clinician. It will be further appreciated that, for convenience and clarity, spatial terms such as “vertical”, “horizontal”, “up”, and “down” may be used herein with respect to the drawings. However, surgical instruments are used in many orientations and positions, and these terms are not intended to be limiting and/or absolute.

Various exemplary devices and methods are provided for performing laparoscopic and minimally invasive surgical procedures. However, the reader will readily appreciate that the various methods and devices disclosed herein can be used in numerous surgical procedures and applications including, for example, in connection with open surgical procedures. As the present Detailed Description proceeds, the reader will further appreciate that the various instruments disclosed herein can be inserted into a body in any way, such as through a natural orifice, through an incision or puncture hole formed in tissue, etc. The working portions or end effector portions of the instruments can be inserted directly into a patient's body or can be inserted through an access device that has a working channel through which the end effector and elongate shaft of a surgical instrument can be advanced.

A surgical stapling system can comprise a shaft and an end effector extending from the shaft. The end effector comprises a first jaw and a second jaw. The first jaw comprises a staple cartridge. The staple cartridge is insertable into and removable from the first jaw; however, other embodiments are envisioned in which a staple cartridge is not removable from, or at least readily replaceable from, the first jaw. The second jaw comprises an anvil configured to deform staples ejected from the staple cartridge. The second jaw is pivotable relative to the first jaw about a closure axis; however, other embodiments are envisioned in which the first jaw is pivotable relative to the second jaw. The surgical stapling system further comprises an articulation joint configured to permit the end effector to be rotated, or articulated, relative to the shaft. The end effector is rotatable about an articulation axis extending through the articulation joint. Other embodiments are envisioned which do not include an articulation joint.

The staple cartridge comprises a cartridge body. The cartridge body includes a proximal end, a distal end, and a deck extending between the proximal end and the distal end. In use, the staple cartridge is positioned on a first side of the tissue to be stapled and the anvil is positioned on a second side of the tissue. The anvil is moved toward the staple cartridge to compress and clamp the tissue against the deck. Thereafter, staples removably stored in the cartridge body can be deployed into the tissue. The cartridge body includes staple cavities defined therein wherein staples are removably stored in the staple cavities. The staple cavities are arranged in six longitudinal rows. Three rows of staple cavities are positioned on a first side of a longitudinal slot and three rows of staple cavities are positioned on a second side of the longitudinal slot. Other arrangements of staple cavities and staples may be possible.

The staples are supported by staple drivers in the cartridge body. The drivers are movable between a first, or unfired position, and a second, or fired, position to eject the staples from the staple cavities. The drivers are retained in the cartridge body by a retainer which extends around the bottom of the cartridge body and includes resilient members configured to grip the cartridge body and hold the retainer to the cartridge body. The drivers are movable between their unfired positions and their fired positions by a sled. The sled is movable between a proximal position adjacent the proximal end and a distal position adjacent the distal end. The sled comprises a plurality of ramped surfaces configured to slide under the drivers and lift the drivers, and the staples supported thereon, toward the anvil.

Further to the above, the sled is moved distally by a firing member. The firing member is configured to contact the sled and push the sled toward the distal end. The longitudinal slot defined in the cartridge body is configured to receive the firing member. The anvil also includes a slot configured to receive the firing member. The firing member further comprises a first cam which engages the first jaw and a second cam which engages the second jaw. As the firing member is advanced distally, the first cam and the second cam can control the distance, or tissue gap, between the deck of the staple cartridge and the anvil. The firing member also comprises a knife configured to incise the tissue captured intermediate the staple cartridge and the anvil. It is desirable for the knife to be positioned at least partially proximal to the ramped surfaces such that the staples are ejected ahead of the knife.

FIG. 1 depicts a motor-driven surgical system 10 that may be used to perform a variety of different surgical procedures. As can be seen in that Figure, one example of the surgical system 10 includes four interchangeable surgical tool assemblies 100, 200, 300, and 1000 that are each adapted for interchangeable use with a handle assembly 500. Each interchangeable surgical tool assembly 100, 200, 300, and 1000 may be designed for use in connection with the performance of one or more specific surgical procedures. In another surgical system embodiment, the interchangeable surgical tool assemblies may be effectively employed with a tool drive assembly of a robotically controlled or automated surgical system. For example, the surgical tool assemblies disclosed herein may be employed with various robotic systems, instruments, components and methods such as, but not limited to, those disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 9,072,535, entitled SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENTS WITH ROTATABLE STAPLE DEPLOYMENT ARRANGEMENTS, which is hereby incorporated by reference herein in its entirety.

FIG. 2 illustrates one form of an interchangeable surgical tool assembly 100 that is operably coupled to the handle assembly 500. FIG. 3 illustrates attachment of the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 100 to the handle assembly 500. The attachment arrangement and process depicted in FIG. 3 may also be employed in connection with attachment of any of the interchangeable surgical tool assemblies 100, 200, 300, and 1000 to a tool drive portion or tool drive housing of a robotic system. The handle assembly 500 may comprise a handle housing 502 that includes a pistol grip portion 504 that can be gripped and manipulated by the clinician. As will be briefly discussed below, the handle assembly 500 operably supports a plurality of drive systems that are configured to generate and apply various control motions to corresponding portions of the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 100, 200, 300, and/or 1000 that is operably attached thereto.

Referring now to FIG. 3 , the handle assembly 500 may further include a frame 506 that operably supports the plurality of drive systems. For example, the frame 506 can operably support a first or closure drive system, generally designated as 510, which may be employed to apply closing and opening motions to the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 100, 200, 300, and 1000 that is operably attached or coupled to the handle assembly 500. In at least one form, the closure drive system 510 may include an actuator in the form of a closure trigger 512 that is pivotally supported by the frame 506. Such an arrangement enables the closure trigger 512 to be manipulated by a clinician such that, when the clinician grips the pistol grip portion 504 of the handle assembly 500, the closure trigger 512 may be pivoted from a starting or “unactuated” position to an “actuated” position and more particularly to a fully compressed or fully actuated position. In various forms, the closure drive system 510 further includes a closure linkage assembly 514 that is pivotally coupled to the closure trigger 512 or otherwise operably interfaces therewith. As will be discussed in further detail below, the closure linkage assembly 514 includes a transverse attachment pin 516 that facilitates attachment to a corresponding drive system on the surgical tool assembly. To actuate the closure drive system, the clinician depresses the closure trigger 512 towards the pistol grip portion 504. As described in further detail in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/226,142, entitled SURGICAL INSTRUMENT COMPRISING A SENSOR SYSTEM, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2015/0272575, which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety herein, the closure drive system is configured to lock the closure trigger 512 into the fully depressed or fully actuated position when the clinician fully depresses the closure trigger 512 to attain the full closure stroke. When the clinician desires to unlock the closure trigger 512 to permit the closure trigger 512 to be biased to the unactuated position, the clinician simply activates a closure release button assembly 518 which enables the closure trigger to return to unactuated position. The closure release button 518 may also be configured to interact with various sensors that communicate with a microcontroller 520 in the handle assembly 500 for tracking the position of the closure trigger 512. Further details concerning the configuration and operation of the closure release button assembly 518 may be found in U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2015/0272575.

In at least one form, the handle assembly 500 and the frame 506 may operably support another drive system referred to herein as a firing drive system 530 that is configured to apply firing motions to corresponding portions of the interchangeable surgical tool assembly that is attached thereto. As was described in detail in U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2015/0272575, the firing drive system 530 may employ an electric motor (not shown in FIGS. 1-3 ) that is located in the pistol grip portion 504 of the handle assembly 500. In various forms, the motor may be a DC brushed driving motor having a maximum speed of approximately 25,000 RPM, for example. In other arrangements, the motor may include a brushless motor, a cordless motor, a synchronous motor, a stepper motor, or any other suitable electric motor. The motor may be powered by a power source 522 that in one form may comprise a removable power pack. The power pack may support a plurality of Lithium Ion (“LI”) or other suitable batteries therein. A number of batteries may be connected in series may be used as the power source 522 for the surgical system 10. In addition, the power source 522 may be replaceable and/or rechargeable.

The electric motor is configured to axially drive a longitudinally movable drive member 540 in distal and proximal directions depending upon the polarity of the voltage applied to the motor. For example, when the motor is driven in one rotary direction, the longitudinally movable drive member 540 the will be axially driven in the distal direction “DD”. When the motor is driven in the opposite rotary direction, the longitudinally movable drive member 540 will be axially driven in a proximal direction “PD”. The handle assembly 500 can include a switch 513 which can be configured to reverse the polarity applied to the electric motor by the power source 522 or otherwise control the motor. The handle assembly 500 can also include a sensor or sensors that are configured to detect the position of the drive member 540 and/or the direction in which the drive member 540 is being moved. Actuation of the motor can be controlled by a firing trigger 532 (FIG. 1 ) that is pivotally supported on the handle assembly 500. The firing trigger 532 may be pivoted between an unactuated position and an actuated position. The firing trigger 532 may be biased into the unactuated position by a spring or other biasing arrangement such that, when the clinician releases the firing trigger 532, the firing trigger 532 may be pivoted or otherwise returned to the unactuated position by the spring or biasing arrangement. In at least one form, the firing trigger 532 can be positioned “outboard” of the closure trigger 512 as was discussed above. As discussed in U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2015/0272575, the handle assembly 500 may be equipped with a firing trigger safety button to prevent inadvertent actuation of the firing trigger 532. When the closure trigger 512 is in the unactuated position, the safety button is contained in the handle assembly 500 where the clinician cannot readily access the safety button and move it between a safety position preventing actuation of the firing trigger 532 and a firing position wherein the firing trigger 532 may be fired. As the clinician depresses the closure trigger 512, the safety button and the firing trigger 532 pivot downwardly where they can then be manipulated by the clinician.

In at least one form, the longitudinally movable drive member 540 may have a rack of teeth formed thereon for meshing engagement with a corresponding drive gear arrangement that interfaces with the motor. Further details regarding those features may be found in U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2015/0272575. In at least one form, the handle assembly 500 also includes a manually-actuatable “bailout” assembly that is configured to enable the clinician to manually retract the longitudinally movable drive member 540 should the motor become disabled. The bailout assembly may include a lever or bailout handle assembly that is stored within the handle assembly 500 under a releasable door 550. The lever is configured to be manually pivoted into ratcheting engagement with the teeth in the drive member 540. Thus, the clinician can manually retract the drive member 540 by using the bailout handle assembly to ratchet the drive member 5400 in the proximal direction “PD”. U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/249,117, entitled POWERED SURGICAL CUTTING AND STAPLING APPARATUS WITH MANUALLY RETRACTABLE FIRING SYSTEM, now U.S. Pat. No. 8,608,045, the entire disclosure of which is hereby incorporated by reference herein, discloses bailout arrangements that may also be employed with the various surgical tool assemblies disclosed herein.

Turning now to FIG. 2 , the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 100 includes a surgical end effector 110 that comprises a first jaw and a second jaw. In one arrangement, the first jaw comprises an elongate channel 112 that is configured to operably support a surgical staple cartridge 116 therein. The second jaw comprises an anvil 114 that is pivotally supported relative to the elongate channel 112. The interchangeable surgical tool assembly 100 also includes a lockable articulation joint 120 which can be configured to releasably hold the end effector 110 in a desired position relative to a shaft axis SA. Details regarding various constructions and operation of the end effector 110, the articulation joint 120 and the articulation lock are set forth in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/803,086, entitled ARTICULATABLE SURGICAL INSTRUMENT COMPRISING AN ARTICULATION LOCK, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0263541, which is hereby incorporated by reference herein in its entirety. As can be further seen in FIGS. 2 and 3 , the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 100 can include a proximal housing or nozzle 130 and a closure tube assembly 140 which can be utilized to close and/or open the anvil 114 of the end effector 110. As discussed in U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2015/0272575, the closure tube assembly 140 is movably supported on a spine 145 which supports an articulation driver arrangement 147 configured to apply articulation motions to the surgical end effector 110. The spine 145 is configured to, one, slidably support a firing bar 170 therein and, two, slidably support the closure tube assembly 140 which extends around the spine 145. In various circumstances, the spine 145 includes a proximal end that is rotatably supported in a chassis 150. See FIG. 3 . In one arrangement, for example, the proximal end of the spine 145 is attached to a spine bearing that is configured to be supported within the chassis 150. Such an arrangement facilitates the rotatable attachment of the spine 145 to the chassis 150 such that the spine 145 may be selectively rotated about a shaft axis SA relative to the chassis 150.

Still referring to FIG. 3 , the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 100 includes a closure shuttle 160 that is slidably supported within the chassis 150 such that the closure shuttle 160 may be axially moved relative to the chassis 150. As can be seen in FIG. 3 , the closure shuttle 160 includes a pair of proximally-protruding hooks 162 that are configured to be attached to the attachment pin 516 that is attached to the closure linkage assembly 514 in the handle assembly 500. A proximal closure tube segment 146 of the closure tube assembly 140 is rotatably coupled to the closure shuttle 160. Thus, when the hooks 162 are hooked over the pin 516, actuation of the closure trigger 512 will result in the axial movement of the closure shuttle 160 and, ultimately, the closure tube assembly 140 on the spine 145. A closure spring may also be journaled on the closure tube assembly 140 and serves to bias the closure tube assembly 140 in the proximal direction “PD” which can serve to pivot the closure trigger 512 into the unactuated position when the shaft assembly 100 is operably coupled to the handle assembly 500. In use, the closure tube assembly 140 is translated distally (direction DD) to close the anvil 114 in response to the actuation of the closure trigger 512. The closure tube assembly 140 includes a distal closure tube segment 142 that is pivotally pinned to a distal end of a proximal closure tube segment 146. The distal closure tube segment 142 is configured to axially move with the proximal closure tube segment 146 relative to the surgical end effector 110. When the distal end of the distal closure tube segment 142 strikes a proximal surface or ledge 115 on the anvil 114, the anvil 114 is pivoted closed. Further details concerning the closure of anvil 114 may be found in the aforementioned U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0263541 and will be discussed in further detail below. As was also described in detail in U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0263541, the anvil 114 is opened by proximally translating the distal closure tube segment 142. The distal closure tube segment 142 has a horseshoe aperture 143 therein that defines a downwardly extending return tab that cooperates with an anvil tab 117 formed on the proximal end of the anvil 114 to pivot the anvil 114 back to an open position. In the fully open position, the closure tube assembly 140 is in its proximal-most or unactuated position.

As was also indicated above, the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 100 further includes a firing bar 170 that is supported for axial travel within the shaft spine 145. The firing bar 170 includes an intermediate firing shaft portion that is configured to be attached to a distal cutting portion or knife bar that is configured for axial travel through the surgical end effector 110. In at least one arrangement, the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 100 includes a clutch assembly which can be configured to selectively and releasably couple the articulation driver to the firing bar 170. Further details regarding the clutch assembly features and operation may be found in U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0263541. As discussed in U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0263541, distal movement of the firing bar 170 can move the articulation driver arrangement 147 distally and, correspondingly, proximal movement of the firing bar 170 can move the articulation driver arrangement 147 proximally when the clutch assembly is in its engaged position. When the clutch assembly is in its disengaged position, movement of the firing bar 170 is not transmitted to the articulation driver arrangement 147 and, as a result, the firing bar 170 can move independently of the articulation driver arrangement 147. The interchangeable surgical tool assembly 100 may also include a slip ring assembly which can be configured to conduct electrical power to and/or from the end effector 110 and/or communicate signals to and/or from the end effector 110. Further details regarding the slip ring assembly may be found in U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0263541. U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/800,067, entitled STAPLE CARTRIDGE TISSUE THICKNESS SENSOR SYSTEM, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0263552 is incorporated by reference in its entirety. U.S. Pat. No. 9,345,481, entitled STAPLE CARTRIDGE TISSUE THICKNESS SENSOR SYSTEM, is also hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety.

Still referring to FIG. 3 , the chassis 150 has one or more tapered attachment portions 152 formed thereon that are adapted to be received within corresponding dovetail slots 507 formed within a distal end of the frame 506. Each dovetail slot 507 may be tapered or, stated another way, may be somewhat V-shaped to seatingly receive the tapered attachment portions 152 therein. As can be further seen in FIG. 3 , a shaft attachment lug 172 is formed on the proximal end of the firing shaft 170. When the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 100 is coupled to the handle assembly 500, the shaft attachment lug 172 is received in a firing shaft attachment cradle 542 formed in the distal end of the longitudinally movable drive member 540. The interchangeable surgical tool assembly 100 also employs a latch system 180 for releasably latching the shaft assembly 100 to the frame 506 of the handle assembly 500. In at least one form, the latch system 180 includes a lock member or lock yoke 182 that is movably coupled to the chassis 150, for example. The lock yoke 182 includes two proximally protruding lock lugs 184 that are configured for releasable engagement with corresponding lock detents or grooves 509 in the distal attachment flange of the frame 506. In various forms, the lock yoke 182 is biased in the proximal direction by spring or biasing member. Actuation of the lock yoke 182 may be accomplished by a latch button 186 that is slidably mounted on a latch actuator assembly that is mounted to the chassis 150. The latch button 186 may be biased in a proximal direction relative to the lock yoke 182. As will be discussed in further detail below, the lock yoke 182 may be moved to an unlocked position by biasing the latch button 186 the in distal direction DD which also causes the lock yoke 182 to pivot out of retaining engagement with the distal attachment flange of the frame 506. When the lock yoke 182 is in retaining engagement with the distal attachment flange of the frame 506, the lock lugs 184 are retainingly seated within the corresponding lock detents or grooves 509 in the distal end of the frame 506. Further details concerning the latching system may be found in U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0263541.

To attach the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 100 to the handle assembly 500 A clinician may position the chassis 150 of the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 100 above or adjacent to the distal end of the frame 506 such that the tapered attachment portions 152 formed on the chassis 150 are aligned with the dovetail slots 507 in the frame 506. The clinician may then move the surgical tool assembly 100 along an installation axis IA that is perpendicular to the shaft axis SA to seat the tapered attachment portions 152 in operable engagement with the corresponding dovetail receiving slots 507 in the distal end of the frame 506. In doing so, the shaft attachment lug 172 on the firing shaft 170 will also be seated in the cradle 542 in the longitudinally movable drive member 540 and the portions of pin 516 on the closure link 514 will be seated in the corresponding hooks 162 in the closure shuttle 160. As used herein, the term “operable engagement” in the context of two components means that the two components are sufficiently engaged with each other so that, upon application of an actuation motion thereto, the components carry out their intended action, function, and/or procedure.

Returning now to FIG. 1 , the surgical system 10 includes four interchangeable surgical tool assemblies 100, 200, 300, and 1000 that may each be effectively employed with the same handle assembly 500 to perform different surgical procedures. The construction of an exemplary form of interchangeable surgical tool assembly 100 was briefly discussed above and is discussed in further detail in U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0263541. Various details regarding interchangeable surgical tool assemblies 200 and 300 may be found in the various U.S. patent applications which have been incorporated by reference herein. Various details regarding interchangeable surgical tool assembly 1000 will be discussed in further detail below.

As illustrated in FIG. 1 , each of the surgical tool assemblies 100, 200, 300, and 1000 includes a pair of jaws wherein at least one of the jaws is movable to capture, manipulate, and/or clamp tissue between the two jaws. The movable jaw is moved between open and closed positions upon the application of closure and opening motions applied thereto from the handle assembly or the robotic or automated surgical system to which the surgical tool assembly is operably coupled. In addition, each of the illustrated interchangeable surgical tool assemblies includes a firing member that is configured to cut tissue and fire staples from a staple cartridge that is supported in one of the jaws in response to firing motions applied thereto by the handle assembly or robotic system. Each surgical tool assembly may be uniquely designed to perform a specific procedure, for example, to cut and fasten a particular type of and thickness of tissue within a certain area in the body. The closing, firing and articulation control systems in the handle assembly 500 or robotic system may be configured to generate axial control motions and/or rotary control motions depending upon the type of closing, firing, and articulation system configurations that are employed in the surgical tool assembly. In one arrangement, one of the closure system control components moves axially from an unactuated position to its fully actuated position when a closure control system in the handle assembly or robotic system is fully actuated. The axial distance that the closure tube assembly moves between its unactuated position to its fully actuated position may be referred to herein as its “closure stroke length”. Similarly, one of the firing system control components moves axially from its unactuated position to its fully actuated or fired position when a firing system in the handle assembly or robotic system is fully actuated. The axial distance that the longitudinally movable drive member moves between its unactuated position and its fully fired position may be referred to herein as its “firing stroke length”. For those surgical tool assemblies that employ articulatable end effector arrangements, the handle assembly or robotic system may employ articulation control components that move axially through an “articulation drive stroke length”. In many circumstances, the closure stroke length, the firing stroke length, and the articulation drive stroke length are fixed for a particular handle assembly or robotic system. Thus, each of the surgical tool assemblies must be able to accommodate control movements of the closure, firing, and/or articulation components through each of their entire stroke lengths without placing undue stress on the surgical tool components which might lead to damage the surgical tool assembly.

Turning now to FIGS. 4-10 , the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 1000 includes a surgical end effector 1100 that comprises an elongate channel 1102 that is configured to operably support a staple cartridge 1110 therein. The end effector 1100 may further include an anvil 1130 that is pivotally supported relative to the elongate channel 1102. The interchangeable surgical tool assembly 1000 may further include an articulation joint 1200 and an articulation lock 1210 (FIGS. 5 and 8-10 ) which can be configured to releasably hold the end effector 1100 in a desired articulated position relative to a shaft axis SA. Details regarding the construction and operation of the articulation lock 1210 may be found in in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/803,086, entitled ARTICULATABLE SURGICAL INSTRUMENT COMPRISING AN ARTICULATION LOCK, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0263541, the entire disclosure of which is hereby incorporated by reference herein. Additional details concerning the articulation lock may also be found in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/019,196, filed Feb. 9, 2016, entitled SURGICAL INSTRUMENT ARTICULATION MECHANISM WITH SLOTTED SECONDARY CONSTRAINT, the entire disclosure of which is hereby incorporated by reference herein. As can be seen in FIG. 7 , the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 1000 can further include a proximal housing or nozzle 1300 comprised of nozzle portions 1302, 1304 as well as an actuator wheel portion 1306 that is configured to be coupled to the assembled nozzle portions 1302, 1304 by snaps, lugs, and/or screws, for example. The interchangeable surgical tool assembly 1000 can further include a closure tube assembly 1400 which can be utilized to close and/or open the anvil 1130 of the end effector 1100 as will be discussed in further detail below. Primarily referring now to FIGS. 8 and 9 , the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 1000 can include a spine assembly 1500 which can be configured to support the articulation lock 1210. The spine assembly 1500 comprises an “elastic” spine or frame member 1510 which will be described in further detail below. A distal end portion 1522 of the elastic spine member 1510 is attached to a distal frame segment 1560 that operably supports the articulation lock 1210 therein. As can be seen in FIGS. 7 and 8 , the spine assembly 1500 is configured to, one, slidably support a firing member assembly 1600 therein and, two, slidably support the closure tube assembly 1400 which extends around the spine assembly 1500. The spine assembly 1500 can also be configured to slidably support a proximal articulation driver 1700.

As can be seen in FIG. 10 , the distal frame segment 1560 is pivotally coupled to the elongate channel 1102 by an end effector mounting assembly 1230. In one arrangement, the distal end 1562 of the distal frame segment 1560 has a pivot pin 1564 formed thereon, for example. The pivot pin 1564 is adapted to be pivotally received within a pivot hole 1234 formed in pivot base portion 1232 of the end effector mounting assembly 1230. The end effector mounting assembly 1230 is attached to the proximal end 1103 of the elongate channel 1102 by a spring pin 1108 or other suitable member. The pivot pin 1564 defines an articulation axis B-B that is transverse to the shaft axis SA. See FIG. 4 . Such an arrangement facilitates pivotal travel (i.e., articulation) of the end effector 1100 about the articulation axis B-B relative to the spine assembly 1500.

Still referring to FIG. 10 , the articulation driver 1700 has a distal end 1702 that is configured to operably engage the articulation lock 1210. The articulation lock 1210 includes an articulation frame 1212 that is adapted to operably engage a drive pin 1238 on the pivot base portion 1232 of the end effector mounting assembly 1230. In addition, a cross-link 1237 may be linked to the drive pin 1238 and articulation frame 1212 to assist articulation of the end effector 1100. As indicated above, further details regarding the operation of the articulation lock 1210 and the articulation frame 1212 may be found in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/803,086, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0263541. Further details regarding the end effector mounting assembly and a crosslink may be found in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/019,245, filed Feb. 9, 2016, entitled SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS WITH CLOSURE STROKE REDUCTION ARRANGEMENTS, the entire disclosure of which is hereby incorporated by reference herein. In various circumstances, the elastic spine member 1510 includes a proximal end 1514 which is rotatably supported in a chassis 1800. In one arrangement, the proximal end 1514 of the elastic spine member 1510 has a thread 1516 formed thereon for threaded attachment to a spine bearing that is configured to be supported within the chassis 1800, for example. Such an arrangement facilitates rotatable attachment of the elastic spine member 1510 to the chassis 1800 such that the spine assembly 1500 may be selectively rotated about a shaft axis SA relative to the chassis 1800.

Referring primarily to FIG. 7 , the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 1000 includes a closure shuttle 1420 that is slidably supported within the chassis 1800 such that the closure shuttle 1420 may be axially moved relative to the chassis 1800. In one form, the closure shuttle 1420 includes a pair of proximally-protruding hooks 1421 that are configured to be attached to the attachment pin 516 that is attached to the closure linkage assembly 514 of the handle assembly 500 as was discussed above. A proximal end 1412 of a proximal closure tube segment 1410 is rotatably coupled to the closure shuttle 1420. For example, a U-shaped connector 1424 is inserted into an annular slot 1414 in the proximal end 1412 of the proximal closure tube segment 1410 and is retained within vertical slots 1422 in the closure shuttle 1420. See FIG. 7 . Such an arrangement serves to attach the proximal closure tube segment 1410 to the closure shuttle 1420 for axial travel therewith while enabling the closure tube assembly 1400 to rotate relative to the closure shuttle 1420 about the shaft axis SA. A closure spring is journaled on the proximal end 1412 of the proximal closure tube segment 1410 and serves to bias the closure tube assembly 1400 in the proximal direction PD which can serve to pivot the closure trigger 512 on the handle assembly 500 (FIG. 3 ) into the unactuated position when the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 1000 is operably coupled to the handle assembly 500.

As indicated above, the illustrated interchangeable surgical tool assembly 1000 includes an articulation joint 1200. Other interchangeable surgical tool assemblies, however, may not be capable of articulation. As can be seen in FIG. 10 , upper and lower tangs 1415, 1416 protrude distally from a distal end of the proximal closure tube segment 1410 which are configured to be movably coupled to an end effector closure sleeve or distal closure tube segment 1430 of the closure tube assembly 1400. As can be seen in FIG. 10 , the distal closure tube segment 1430 includes upper and lower tangs 1434, 1436 that protrude proximally from a proximal end thereof. An upper double pivot link 1220 includes proximal and distal pins that engage corresponding holes in the upper tangs 1415, 1434 of the proximal closure tube segment 1410 and distal closure tube segment 1430, respectively. Similarly, a lower double pivot link 1222 includes proximal and distal pins that engage corresponding holes in the lower tangs 1416 and 1436 of the proximal closure tube segment 1410 and distal closure tube segment 1430, respectively. As will be discussed in further detail below, distal and proximal axial translation of the closure tube assembly 1400 will result in the closing and opening of the anvil 1130 relative to the elongate channel 1102.

As mentioned above, the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 1000 further includes a firing member assembly 1600 that is supported for axial travel within the spine assembly 1500. The firing member assembly 1600 includes an intermediate firing shaft portion 1602 that is configured to be attached to a distal cutting portion or knife bar 1610. The firing member assembly 1600 may also be referred to herein as a “second shaft” and/or a “second shaft assembly”. As can be seen in FIGS. 7-10 , the intermediate firing shaft portion 1602 may include a longitudinal slot 1604 in the distal end thereof which can be configured to receive a tab on the proximal end of the knife bar 1610. The longitudinal slot 1604 and the proximal end of the knife bar 1610 can be sized and configured to permit relative movement therebetween and can comprise a slip joint 1612. The slip joint 1612 can permit the intermediate firing shaft portion 1602 of the firing member assembly 1600 to be moved to articulate the end effector 1100 without moving, or at least substantially moving, the knife bar 1610. Once the end effector 1100 has been suitably oriented, the intermediate firing shaft portion 1602 can be advanced distally until a proximal sidewall of the longitudinal slot 1604 comes into contact with the tab on the knife bar 1610 to advance the knife bar 1610 and fire the staple cartridge 1110 positioned within the elongate channel 1102. As can be further seen in FIGS. 8 and 9 , the elastic spine member 1520 has an elongate opening or window 1525 therein to facilitate the assembly and insertion of the intermediate firing shaft portion 1602 into the elastic spine member 1520. Once the intermediate firing shaft portion 1602 has been inserted therein, a top frame segment 1527 may be engaged with the elastic spine member 1520 to enclose the intermediate firing shaft portion 1602 and knife bar 1610 therein. Further description of the operation of the firing member assembly 1600 may be found in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/803,086, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0263541.

Further to the above, the interchangeable tool assembly 1000 can include a clutch assembly 1620 which can be configured to selectively and releasably couple the articulation driver 1700 to the firing member assembly 1600. In one form, the clutch assembly 1620 includes a lock collar, or sleeve 1622, positioned around the firing member assembly 1600 wherein the lock sleeve 1622 can be rotated between an engaged position in which the lock sleeve 1622 couples the articulation driver 1700 to the firing member assembly 1600 and a disengaged position in which the articulation driver 1700 is not operably coupled to the firing member assembly 1600. When the lock sleeve 1622 is in its engaged position, distal movement of the firing member assembly 1600 can move the articulation driver 1700 distally and, correspondingly, proximal movement of the firing member assembly 1600 can move the articulation driver 1700 proximally. When the lock sleeve 1622 is in its disengaged position, movement of the firing member assembly 1600 is not transmitted to the articulation driver 1700 and, as a result, the firing member assembly 1600 can move independently of the articulation driver 1700. In various circumstances, the articulation driver 1700 can be held in position by the articulation lock 1210 when the articulation driver 1700 is not being moved in the proximal or distal directions by the firing member assembly 1600.

Referring primarily to FIG. 7 , the lock sleeve 1622 can comprise a cylindrical, or an at least substantially cylindrical, body including a longitudinal aperture 1624 defined therein configured to receive the firing member assembly 1600. The lock sleeve 1622 can comprise diametrically-opposed, inwardly-facing lock protrusions 1626, 1628 and an outwardly-facing lock member 1629. The lock protrusions 1626, 1628 can be configured to be selectively engaged with the intermediate firing shaft portion 1602 of the firing member assembly 1600. More particularly, when the lock sleeve 1622 is in its engaged position, the lock protrusions 1626, 1628 are positioned within a drive notch 1605 defined in the intermediate firing shaft portion 1602 such that a distal pushing force and/or a proximal pulling force can be transmitted from the firing member assembly 1600 to the lock sleeve 1622. When the lock sleeve 1622 is in its engaged position, the second lock member 1629 is received within a drive notch 1704 defined in the articulation driver 1700 such that the distal pushing force and/or the proximal pulling force applied to the lock sleeve 1622 can be transmitted to the articulation driver 1700. In effect, the firing member assembly 1600, the lock sleeve 1622, and the articulation driver 1700 will move together when the lock sleeve 1622 is in its engaged position. On the other hand, when the lock sleeve 1622 is in its disengaged position, the lock protrusions 1626, 1628 may not be positioned within the drive notch 1605 of the intermediate firing shaft portion 1602 of the firing member assembly 1600 and, as a result, a distal pushing force and/or a proximal pulling force may not be transmitted from the firing member assembly 1600 to the lock sleeve 1622. Correspondingly, the distal pushing force and/or the proximal pulling force may not be transmitted to the articulation driver 1700. In such circumstances, the firing member assembly 1600 can be slid proximally and/or distally relative to the lock sleeve 1622 and the proximal articulation driver 1700. The clutching assembly 1620 further includes a switch drum 1630 that interfaces with the lock sleeve 1622. Further details concerning the operation of the switch drum and lock sleeve 1622 may be found in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/803,086, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0263541, and Ser. No. 15/019,196. The switch drum 1630 can further comprise at least partially circumferential openings 1632, 1634 defined therein which can receive circumferential mounts 1305 that extend from the nozzle halves 1302, 1304 and permit relative rotation, but not translation, between the switch drum 1630 and the proximal nozzle 1300. See FIG. 6 . Rotation of the nozzle 1300 to a point where the mounts reach the end of their respective slots 1632, 1634 in the switch drum 1630 will result in rotation of the switch drum 1630 about the shaft axis SA. Rotation of the switch drum 1630 will ultimately result in the movement of the lock sleeve 1622 between its engaged and disengaged positions. Thus, in essence, the nozzle 1300 may be employed to operably engage and disengage the articulation drive system with the firing drive system in the various manners described in further detail in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/803,086, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0263541, and U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/019,196, which have each been herein incorporated by reference in their respective entirety.

In the illustrated arrangement, the switch drum 1630 includes a an L-shaped slot 1636 that extends into a distal opening 1637 in the switch drum 1630. The distal opening 1637 receives a transverse pin 1639 of a shifter plate 1638. In one example, the shifter plate 1638 is received within a longitudinal slot that is provided in the lock sleeve 1622 to facilitate the axial movement of the lock sleeve 1622 when engaged with the articulation driver 1700. Further details regarding the operation of the shifter plate and shift drum arrangements may be found in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/868,718, filed Sep. 28, 2015, entitled SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENT WITH SHAFT RELEASE, POWERED FIRING AND POWERED ARTICULATION, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2017/0086823, the entire disclosure of which is hereby incorporated by reference herein.

As also illustrated in FIGS. 7 and 8 , the interchangeable tool assembly 1000 can comprise a slip ring assembly 1640 which can be configured to conduct electrical power to and/or from the end effector 1100, and/or communicate signals to and/or from the end effector 1100, back to a microprocessor in the handle assembly or robotic system controller, for example. Further details concerning the slip ring assembly 1640 and associated connectors may be found in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/803,086, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0263541, and U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/019,196 which have each been herein incorporated by reference in their respective entirety as well as in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/800,067, entitled STAPLE CARTRIDGE TISSUE THICKNESS SENSOR SYSTEM, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0263552, which is hereby incorporated by reference herein in its entirety. As also described in further detail in the aforementioned patent applications that have been incorporated by reference herein, the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 1000 can also comprise at least one sensor that is configured to detect the position of the switch drum 1630.

Referring again to FIG. 7 , the chassis 1800 includes one or more tapered attachment portions 1802 formed thereon that are adapted to be received within corresponding dovetail slots 507 formed within the distal end portion of the frame 506 of the handle assembly 500 as was discussed above. As can be further seen in FIG. 7 , a shaft attachment lug 1605 is formed on the proximal end of the intermediate firing shaft 1602. As will be discussed in further detail below, the shaft attachment lug 1605 is received in a firing shaft attachment cradle 542 that is formed in the distal end of the longitudinal drive member 540 when the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 1000 is coupled to the handle assembly 500. See FIG. 3 .

Various interchangeable surgical tool assemblies employ a latch system 1810 for removably coupling the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 1000 to the frame 506 of the handle assembly 500. In at least one form, as can be seen in FIG. 7 , the latch system 1810 includes a lock member or lock yoke 1812 that is movably coupled to the chassis 1800. The lock yoke 1812 has a U-shape with two spaced downwardly extending legs 1814. The legs 1814 each have a pivot lug formed thereon that are adapted to be received in corresponding holes 1816 formed in the chassis 1800. Such an arrangement facilitates the pivotal attachment of the lock yoke 1812 to the chassis 1800. The lock yoke 1812 may include two proximally protruding lock lugs 1818 that are configured for releasable engagement with corresponding lock detents or grooves 509 in the distal end of the frame 506 of the handle assembly 500. See FIG. 3 . In various forms, the lock yoke 1812 is biased in the proximal direction by a spring or biasing member 1819. Actuation of the lock yoke 1812 may be accomplished by a latch button 1820 that is slidably mounted on a latch actuator assembly 1822 that is mounted to the chassis 1800. The latch button 1820 may be biased in a proximal direction relative to the lock yoke 1812. The lock yoke 1812 may be moved to an unlocked position by biasing the latch button 1820 the in distal direction which also causes the lock yoke 1812 to pivot out of retaining engagement with the distal end of the frame 506. When the lock yoke 1812 is in retaining engagement with the distal end of the frame 506, the lock lugs 1818 are retainingly seated within the corresponding lock detents or grooves 509 in the distal end of the frame 506.

In the illustrated arrangement, the lock yoke 1812 includes at least one and preferably two lock hooks 1824 that are adapted to contact corresponding lock lug portions 1426 that are formed on the closure shuttle 1420. When the closure shuttle 1420 is in an unactuated position, the lock yoke 1812 may be pivoted in a distal direction to unlock the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 1000 from the handle assembly 500. When in that position, the lock hooks 1824 do not contact the lock lug portions 1426 on the closure shuttle 1420. However, when the closure shuttle 1420 is moved to an actuated position, the lock yoke 1812 is prevented from being pivoted to an unlocked position. Stated another way, if the clinician were to attempt to pivot the lock yoke 1812 to an unlocked position or, for example, the lock yoke 1812 was in advertently bumped or contacted in a manner that might otherwise cause it to pivot distally, the lock hooks 1824 on the lock yoke 1812 will contact the lock lugs 1426 on the closure shuttle 1420 and prevent movement of the lock yoke 1812 to an unlocked position.

Still referring to FIG. 10 , the knife bar 1610 may comprise a laminated beam structure that includes at least two beam layers. Such beam layers may comprise, for example, stainless steel bands that are interconnected by, for example, welds and/or pins at their proximal ends and/or at other locations along the length of the bands. In alternative embodiments, the distal ends of the bands are not connected together to allow the laminates or bands to splay relative to each other when the end effector is articulated. Such an arrangement permits the knife bar 1610 to be sufficiently flexible to accommodate articulation of the end effector. Various laminated knife bar arrangements are disclosed in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/019,245. As can also be seen in FIG. 10 , a middle support member 1614 is employed to provide lateral support to the knife bar 1610 as it flexes to accommodate articulation of the surgical end effector 1100. Further details concerning the middle support member and alternative knife bar support arrangements are disclosed in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/019,245. As can also be seen in FIG. 10 , a firing member or knife member 1620 is attached to the distal end of the knife bar 1610.

FIG. 11 illustrates one form of a firing member 1660 that may be employed with the interchangeable tool assembly 1000. The firing member 1660 comprises a body portion 1662 that includes a proximally extending connector member 1663 that is configured to be received in a correspondingly shaped connector opening 1614 in the distal end of the knife bar 1610. See FIG. 10 . The connector 1663 may be retained within the connector opening 1614 by friction, welding, and/or a suitable adhesive, for example. Referring to FIGS. 15-17 , the body portion 1662 protrudes through an elongate slot 1104 in the elongate channel 1102 and terminates in a foot member 1664 that extends laterally on each side of the body portion 1662. As the firing member 1660 is driven distally through the surgical staple cartridge 1110, the foot member 1664 rides within a passage in the elongate channel 1102 that is located under the surgical staple cartridge 1110. As can be seen in FIG. 11 , the firing member 1660 may further include laterally protruding central tabs, pins, or retainer features 1680. As the firing member 1660 is driven distally through the surgical staple cartridge 1110, the central retainer features 1680 ride on the inner surface 1106 of the elongate channel 1102. The body portion 1662 of the firing member 1660 further includes a tissue cutting edge or feature 1666 that is disposed between a distally protruding shoulder 1665 and a distally protruding top nose portion 1670. As can be further seen in FIG. 11 , the firing member 1660 may further include two laterally extending top tabs, pins or anvil engagement features 1665. See FIGS. 13 and 14 . As the firing member 1660 is driven distally, a top portion of the body 1662 extends through a centrally disposed anvil slot 1138 (FIG. 14 ) and the top anvil engagement features 1672 ride on corresponding ledges 1136 formed on each side of the anvil slot 1134.

Returning to FIG. 10 , the firing member 1660 is configured to operably interface with a sled 1120 that is supported within the body 1111 of the surgical staple cartridge 1110. The sled 1120 is slidably displaceable within the surgical staple cartridge body 1111 from a proximal starting position adjacent the proximal end 1112 of the cartridge body 1111 to an ending position adjacent a distal end 1113 of the cartridge body 1111. The cartridge body 1111 operably supports therein a plurality of staple drivers (not shown in FIG. 10 ) that are aligned in rows on each side of a centrally disposed slot 1114. The centrally disposed slot 1114 enables the firing member 1660 to pass therethrough and cut the tissue that is clamped between the anvil 1130 and the staple cartridge 1110. The drivers are associated with corresponding pockets 1115 that open through the upper deck surface of the cartridge body. Each of the staple drivers supports one or more surgical staples or fasteners thereon. The sled 1120 includes a plurality of sloped or wedge-shaped cams 1122 wherein each cam 1122 corresponds to a particular line of fasteners or drivers located on a side of the slot 1114. In the illustrated example, one cam 1122 is aligned with one line of “double” drivers that each support two staples or fasteners thereon and another cam 1122 is aligned with another line of “single” drivers on the same side of the slot 1114 that each support a single surgical staple or fastener thereon. Thus, in the illustrated example, when the surgical staple cartridge 1110 is “fired”, there will be three lines of staples on each lateral side of the tissue cut line. However, other cartridge and driver configurations could also be employed to fire other staple/fastener arrangements. The sled 1120 has a central body portion 1124 that is configured to be engaged by the shoulder 1665 of the firing member 1660. When the firing member 1660 is fired or driven distally, the firing member 1660 drives the sled 1120 distally as well. As the firing member 1660 moves distally through the cartridge 1110, the tissue cutting feature 1666 cuts the tissue that is clamped between the anvil assembly 1130 and the cartridge 1110 and, also, the sled 1120 drives the drivers upwardly in the cartridge which drive the corresponding staples or fasteners into forming contact with the anvil assembly 1130.

In embodiments where the firing member includes a tissue cutting surface, it may be desirable for the elongate shaft assembly to be configured in such a way so as to prevent the inadvertent advancement of the firing member unless an unspent staple cartridge is properly supported in the elongate channel 1102 of the surgical end effector 1100. If, for example, no staple cartridge is present at all and the firing member is distally advanced through the end effector, the tissue would be severed, but not stapled. Similarly, if a spent staple cartridge (i.e., a staple cartridge wherein at least some of the staples have already been fired therefrom) is present in the end effector and the firing member is advanced, the tissue would be severed, but may not be completely stapled, if at all. It will be appreciated that such occurrences could lead to undesirable results during the surgical procedure. U.S. Pat. No. 6,988,649 entitled SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENT HAVING A SPENT CARTRIDGE LOCKOUT, U.S. Pat. No. 7,044,352 entitled SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENT HAVING A SINGLE LOCKOUT MECHANISM FOR PREVENTION OF FIRING, and U.S. Pat. No. 7,380,695 entitled SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENT HAVING A SINGLE LOCKOUT MECHANISM FOR PREVENTION OF FIRING, and U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/742,933, entitled SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENTS WITH LOCKOUT ARRANGEMENTS FOR PREVENTING FIRING SYSTEM ACTUATION WHEN A CARTRIDGE IS SPENT OR MISSING each disclose various firing member lockout arrangements. Each of those references is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety herein.

An “unfired”, “unspent”, “fresh” or “new” fastener cartridge 1110 means that the fastener cartridge 1110 has all of its fasteners in their “ready-to-be-fired positions”. The new cartridge 1110 is seated within the elongate channel 1102 and may be retained therein by snap features on the cartridge body that are configured to retainingly engage corresponding portions of the elongate channel 1102. FIGS. 15 and 18 illustrate a portion of the surgical end effector 1100 with a new or unfired surgical staple cartridge 1110 seated therein. As can be seen in FIGS. 15 and 18 , the sled 1120 is in its starting position. To prevent the firing system from being activated and, more precisely, to prevent the firing member 1660 from being distally driven through the end effector 1110 unless an unfired or new surgical staple cartridge has been properly seated within the elongate channel 1102, the interchangeable surgical tool assembly 1000 employs a firing member lockout system generally designated as 1650.

Referring now to FIGS. 10 and 15-19 , the firing member lockout system 1650 includes a movable lock member 1652 that is configured to retainingly engage the firing member 1660 when a new surgical staple cartridge 1110 is not seated properly within the elongate channel 1102. More specifically, the lock member 1652 comprises at least one laterally moving locking portion 1654 that is configured to retainingly engage a corresponding portion of the firing member 1660 when the sled 1120 is not present within the cartridge 1110 in its starting position. In fact, the lock member 1652 employs two laterally moving locking portions 1654 which each engage a laterally extending portion of the firing member 1660. Other lockout arrangements can be used.

The lock member 1652 comprises a generally U-shaped spring member where each laterally movable leg or locking portion 1654 extends from a central spring portion 1653 and is configured to move in lateral directions represented by “L” in FIGS. 18 and 19 . It will be appreciated that the term “lateral directions” refers to directions that are transverse to the shaft axis SA (FIG. 2 ). The spring or lock member 1652 may be fabricated from high strength spring steel and/or a similar material, for example. The central spring portion 1653 is seated within a slot 1236 in the end effector mounting assembly 1230. See FIG. 10 . As can be seen in FIGS. 15-17 , each of the laterally movable legs or locking portions 1654 has a distal end 1656 with a locking window 1658 therein. When the locking member 1652 is in a locked position, the central retainer feature 1680 on each lateral side of the firing member 1660 extends into corresponding locking windows 1658 defined in the locking portions 1654 to retainingly prevent the firing member from being distally, or axially, advanced.

Operation of the firing member lock out system will be explained with reference to FIGS. 15-19 . FIGS. 15 and 18 illustrate a portion of the surgical end effector 1100 with a new unfired cartridge 1110 properly installed therein. As can be seen in FIGS. 15 and 18 , the sled 1120 includes an unlocking feature 1126 that corresponds to each of the laterally movable locking portions 1654. An unlocking feature 1126 is provided on or extends proximally from each of the central wedge-shaped cams 1122. In alternative arrangements, the unlocking feature 1126 may comprise a proximally protruding portion of the corresponding wedge-shaped cam 1122. As can be seen in FIG. 18 , the unlocking features 1124 engage and bias the corresponding locking portions 1654 laterally in a direction that is transverse to the shaft axis SA (FIG. 2 ) when the sled 1120 is in its starting position. When the locking portions 1654 are in such unlocked orientations, the central retainer features 1680 are not in retaining engagement with the locking windows 1658. In such instances, the firing member 1660 may be distally, or axially, advanced (fired). However, when a cartridge is not present in the elongate channel 1102 or the sled 1120 has been moved out of its starting position (meaning the cartridge is partially or completely fired), the locking portions 1654 spring laterally into retaining engagement with the firing member 1660. In such instances, referring to FIG. 19 , the firing member 1660 cannot be moved distally.

FIGS. 16 and 17 illustrate the retraction of the firing member 1660 back to its starting, or unfired, position after performing a staple firing stroke as discussed above. FIG. 16 depicts the initial reengagement of the retaining features 1680 into their corresponding locking windows 1658. FIG. 17 illustrates the retaining feature in its locked position when the firing member 1660 has been fully retracted back to its starting position. To assist in the lateral displacement of the locking portions 1654 when they are contacted by the proximally moving retaining features 1680, each of the retaining features 1680 may be provided with a proximally-facing, laterally-tapered end portion. Such a lockout system prevents the actuation of the firing member 1660 when a new unfired cartridge is not present or when a new unfired cartridge is present, but has not been properly seated in the elongate channel 1102. In addition, the lockout system may prevent the clinician from distally advancing the firing member in the case where a spent or partially fired cartridge has been inadvertently properly seated within the elongate channel. Another advantage that may be provided by the lockout system 1650 is that, unlike other firing member lock out arrangements that require movement of the firing member into and out of alignment with the corresponding slots/passages in the staple cartridge, the firing member 1660 remains in alignment with the cartridge passages while in the locked and unlocked positions. The locking portions 1654 are designed to move laterally into and out of engagement with corresponding sides of the firing member. Such lateral movement of the locking portions or portion is distinguishable from other locking arrangements that move in vertical directions to engage and disengage portions of the firing member.

Returning to FIGS. 13 and 14 , the anvil 1130 includes an elongate anvil body portion 1132 and a proximal anvil mounting portion 1150. The elongate anvil body portion 1132 includes an outer surface 1134 that defines two downwardly extending tissue stop members 1136 that are adjacent to the proximal anvil mounting portion 1150. The elongate anvil body portion 1132 also includes an underside 1135 that defines an elongate anvil slot 1138. In the illustrated arrangement shown in FIG. 14 , the anvil slot 1138 is centrally disposed in the underside 1135. The underside 1135 includes three rows 1140, 1141, 1142 of staple forming pockets 1143, 1144 and 1145 located on each side of the anvil slot 1138. Adjacent each side of the anvil slot 1138 are two elongate anvil passages 1146. Each passage 1146 has a proximal ramp portion 1148. See FIG. 13 . As the firing member 1660 is advanced distally, the top anvil engagement features 1632 initially enter the corresponding proximal ramp portions 1148 and into the corresponding elongate anvil passages 1146.

Turning to FIGS. 12 and 13 , the anvil slot 1138, as well as the proximal ramp portion 1148, extend into the anvil mounting portion 1150. Stated another way, the anvil slot 1138 divides or bifurcates the anvil mounting portion 1150 into two anvil attachment flanges 1151. The anvil attachments flanges 1151 are coupled together at their proximal ends by a connection bridge 1153. The connection bridge 1153 supports the anvil attachment flanges 1151 and can serve to make the anvil mounting portion 1150 more rigid than the mounting portions of other anvil arrangements which are not connected at their proximal ends. As can also be seen in FIGS. 12 and 14 , the anvil slot 1138 has a wide portion 1139 to accommodate the top portion including the top anvil engagement features 1632, of the firing member 1660 when the firing member 1660 is in its proximal unfired position.

As can be seen in FIGS. 13 and 20-24 , each of the anvil attachment flanges 1151 includes a transverse mounting hole 1156 that is configured to receive a pivot pin 1158 (FIGS. 10 and 20 ) therethrough. The anvil mounting portion 1150 is pivotally pinned to the proximal end 1103 of the elongate channel 1102 by the pivot pin 1158 which extends through mounting holes 1107 in the proximal end 1103 of the elongate channel 1102 and the mounting hole 1156 in anvil mounting portion 1150. Such an arrangement pivotally affixes the anvil 1130 to the elongate channel 1102 s that the anvil 1130 can be pivoted about a fixed anvil axis A-A which is transverse to the shaft axis SA. See FIG. 5 . The anvil mounting portion 1150 also includes a cam surface 1152 that extends from a centralized firing member parking area 1154 to the outer surface 1134 of the anvil body portion 1132.

Further to the above, the anvil 1130 is movable between an open position and closed positions by axially advancing and retracting the distal closure tube segment 1430, as discussed further below. A distal end portion of the distal closure tube segment 1430 has an internal cam surface formed thereon that is configured to engage the cam surface 1552, or cam surfaces formed on the anvil mounting portion 1150, and move the anvil 1130. FIG. 22 illustrates a cam surface 1152 a formed on the anvil mounting portion 1150 so as to establish a single contact path 1155 a with the internal cam surface 1444, for example, on the distal closure tube segment 1430. FIG. 23 illustrates a cam surface 1152 b that is configured relative to the internal cam surface 1444 on the distal closure tube segment to establish two separate and distinct arcuate contact paths 1155 b between the cam surface 1152 on the anvil mounting portion 1150 and internal cam surface 1444 on the distal closure tube segment 1430. In addition to other potential advantages discussed herein, such an arrangement may better distribute the closure forces from the distal closure tube segment 1430 to the anvil 1130. FIG. 24 illustrates a cam surface 1152 c that is configured relative to the internal cam surface 1444 of the distal closure tube segment 1430 to establish three distinct zones of contact 1155 c and 1155 d between the cam surfaces on the anvil mounting portion 1150 and the distal closure tube segment 1430. The zones 1155 c, 1155 d establish larger areas of camming contact between the cam surface or cam surfaces on the distal closure tube segment 1430 and the anvil mounting portion 1150 and may better distribute the closure forces to the anvil 1130.

As the distal closure tube segment 1430 cammingly engages the anvil mounting portion 1150 of the anvil 1130, the anvil 1130 is pivoted about the anvil axis AA (FIG. 5 ) which results in the pivotal movement of the distal end of the end 1133 of elongate anvil body portion 1132 toward the surgical staple cartridge 1110 and the distal end 1105 of the elongate channel 1102. As the anvil body portion 1132 begins to pivot, it contacts the tissue that is to be cut and stapled which is now positioned between the underside 1135 of the elongate anvil body portion 1132 and the deck 1116 of the surgical staple cartridge 1110. As the anvil body portion 1132 is compressed onto the tissue, the anvil 1130 may experience considerable amounts of resistive forces and/or bending loads, for example. These resistive forces are overcome as the distal closure tube 1430 continues its distal advancement. However, depending upon their magnitudes and points of application to the anvil body portion 1132, these resistive forces could tend to cause portions of the anvil 1130 to flex away from the staple cartridge 1110 which may generally be undesirable. For example, such flexure may cause misalignment between the firing member 1660 and the passages 1148, 1146 within the anvil 1130. In instances wherein the flexure is excessive, such flexure could significantly increase the amount of firing force required to fire the instrument (i.e., drive the firing member 1660 through the tissue from its starting to ending position). Such excessive firing force may result in damage to the end effector, the firing member, the knife bar, and/or the firing drive system components, for example. Thus, it may be advantageous for the anvil to be constructed so as to resist such flexure.

FIGS. 25-27 illustrate an anvil 1130′ that includes features that improve the stiffness of the anvil body and its resistance to flexure forces that may be generated during the closing and/or firing processes. The anvil 1130′ may otherwise be identical in construction to the anvil 1130 described above except for the differences discussed herein. As can be seen in FIGS. 25-27 , the anvil 1130′ has an elongate anvil body 1132′ that has an upper body portion 1165 that and anvil cap 1170 attached thereto. The anvil cap 1170 is roughly rectangular in shape and has an outer cap perimeter 1172, although the anvil cap 1170 can have any suitable shape. The perimeter 1172 of the anvil cap 1170 is configured to be inserted into a correspondingly-shaped opening 1137 formed in the upper body portion 1165 and positioned against axially extending internal ledge portions 1139 formed therein. See FIG. 27 . The internal ledge portions 1139 are configured to support the corresponding long sides 1177 of the anvil cap 1170. In an alternative embodiment, the anvil cap 1170 may be slid onto the internal ledges 1139 through an opening in the distal end 1133 of the anvil body 1132′. In yet another embodiment, no internal ledge portions are provided. The anvil body 1132′ and the anvil cap 1170 may be fabricated from suitable metal that is conducive to welding. A first weld 1178 may extend around the entire cap perimeter 1172 of the anvil cap 1170 or it may only be located along the long sides 1177 of the anvil cap 1170 and not the distal end 1173 and/or proximal end 1175 thereof. The first weld 1178 may be continuous or it may be discontinuous or intermittent. In those embodiments where the first weld 1178 is discontinuous or intermittent, the weld segments may be equally distributed along the long sides 1177 of the anvil cap 1170, more densely spaced closer to the distal ends of the long sides 1177, and/or more densely spaced closer to the proximal ends of the long sides 1177. In certain arrangements, the weld segments may be more densely spaced in the center areas of the long sides 1177 of the anvil cap 1170.

FIGS. 28-30 illustrate an anvil cap 1170′ that is configured to be mechanically interlocked to the anvil body 1132′ as well as welded to the upper body portion 1165. In this embodiment, a plurality of retention formations 1182 are defined in the wall 1180 of the upper body portion 1165 that defines opening 1137. As used in this context, the term “mechanically interlocked” means that the anvil cap will remain affixed to the elongate anvil body regardless of the orientation of the elongate anvil body and without any additional retaining or fastening such as welding and/or adhesive, for example. The retention formations 1182 may protrude inwardly into the opening 1137 from the opening wall 1180, although any suitable arrangement can be used. The retention formations 1182 may be integrally formed into the wall 1180 or otherwise be attached thereto. The retention formations 1182 are designed to frictionally engage a corresponding portion of the anvil cap 1170′ when the anvil cap 1170′ is installed in the opening 1137 to frictionally retain the anvil cap 1170′ therein. The retention formations 1182 protrude inwardly into the opening 1137 and are configured to be frictionally received within a correspondingly shaped engagement area 1184 formed in the outer perimeter 1172′ of the anvil cap 1170′. The retention formations 1182 only correspond to the long sides 1177′ of the anvil cap 1170′ and are not provided in the portions of the wall 1180 that correspond to the distal end 1173 or proximal end 1175 of the anvil cap 1170′. In alternative arrangements, the retention formations 1182 may also be provided in the portions of the wall 1180 that correspond to the distal end 1173 and proximal end 1175 of the anvil cap 1170′ as well as the long sides 1177′ thereof. In still other arrangements, the retention formations 1182 may only be provided in the portions of the wall 1180 that correspond to one or both of the distal and proximal ends 1173, 1175 of the anvil cap 1170′. In still other arrangements, the retention formations 1182 may be provided in the portions of the wall 1180 corresponding to the long sides 1177′ and only one of the proximal and distal ends 1173, 1175 of the anvil cap 1170′. It will be further understood that the retention protrusions in all of the foregoing embodiments may be alternatively formed on the anvil cap with the engagement areas being formed in the elongate anvil body.

In the embodiment illustrated in FIGS. 28-30 , the retention formations 1182 are equally spaced or equally distributed along the wall portions 1180 of the anvil cap 1170′. In alternative embodiments, the retention formations 1182 may be more densely spaced closer to the distal ends of the long sides 1177′ or more densely spaced closer to the proximal ends of the long sides 1177′. Stated another way, the spacing between those retention formations adjacent the distal end, the proximal end or both the distal and proximal ends may be less than the spacing of the formations located in the central portion of the anvil cap 1170′. In still other arrangements, the retention formations 1182 may be more densely spaced in the center areas of the long sides 1177′ of the anvil cap 1170′. In some alternative embodiments, the correspondingly shaped engagement areas 1184 may not be provided in the outer perimeter 1172′ or in portions of the outer perimeter 1172′ of the anvil cap 1170′. In other embodiments, the retention formations and correspondingly-shaped engagement areas may be provided with different shapes and sizes. In alternative arrangements, the retention formations may be sized relative to the engagement areas so that there is no interference fit therebetween. In such arrangements, the anvil cap may be retained in position by welding, and/or an adhesive, for example.

In the illustrated example, a weld 1178′ extends around the entire perimeter 1172′ of the anvil cap 1170′. Alternatively, the weld 1178′ is located along the long sides 1177′ of the anvil cap 1170′ and not the distal end 1173 and/or proximal end 1175 thereof. The weld 1178′ may be continuous or it may be discontinuous or intermittent. In those embodiments where the weld 1178′ is discontinuous or intermittent, the weld segments may be equally distributed along the long sides 1177′ of the anvil cap 1170′ or the weld segments may be more densely spaced closer to the distal ends of the long sides 1177′ or more densely spaced closer to the proximal ends of the long sides 1177′. In still other arrangements, the weld segments may be more densely spaced in the center areas of the long sides 1177′ of the anvil cap 1170′.

FIGS. 31 and 32 illustrate another anvil arrangement 1130″ that has an anvil cap 1170″ attached thereto. The anvil cap 1170″ is roughly rectangular in shape and has an outer cap perimeter 1172″; however, the anvil cap 1170″ can comprise of any suitable configuration. The outer cap perimeter 1172″ is configured to be inserted into a correspondingly-shaped opening 1137″ in upper body portion 1165 of the anvil body 1132″ and received on axially extending internal ledge portions 1139″ and 1190″ formed therein. See FIG. 32 . The ledge portions 1139″ and 1190″ are configured to support the corresponding long sides 1177″ of the anvil cap 1170″. In an alternative embodiment, the anvil cap 1170″ is slid onto the internal ledges 1139″ and 1190″ through an opening in the distal end 1133″ of the anvil body 1132′. The anvil body 1132″ and the anvil cap 1170″ may be fabricated from metal material that is conducive to welding. A first weld 1178″ may extend around the entire perimeter 1172″ of the anvil cap 1170″ or it may only be located along the long sides 1177″ of the anvil cap 1170″ and not the distal end 1173″ and/or proximal end thereof. The weld 1178″ may be continuous or it may be discontinuous or intermittent. It will be appreciated that the continuous weld embodiment has more weld surface area due to the irregularly shape perimeter of the anvil cap 1170″ as compared to the embodiments with a straight perimeter sides such as the anvil caps shown in FIG. 26 , for example. In those embodiments where the weld 1178″ is discontinuous or intermittent, the weld segments may be equally distributed along the long sides 1177″ of the anvil cap 1170″ or the weld segments may be more densely spaced closer to the distal ends of the long sides 1177″ or more densely spaced closer to the proximal ends of the long sides 1177″. In still other arrangements, the weld segments may be more densely spaced in the center areas of the long sides 1177″ of the anvil cap 1170″.

Still referring to FIGS. 31 and 32 , the anvil cap 1170″ may be additionally welded to the anvil body 1132″ by a plurality of second discrete “deep” welds 1192″. For example, each weld 1192″ may be placed at the bottom of a corresponding hole or opening 1194″ provided through the anvil cap 1170″ so that a discrete weld 1192″ may be formed along the portion of the anvil body 1132″ between the ledges 1190″ and 1139″. See FIG. 32 . The welds 1192″ may be equally distributed along the long sides 1177″ of the anvil cap 1170″ or the welds 1192″ may be more densely spaced closer to the distal ends of the long sides 1177″ or more densely spaced closer to the proximal ends of the long sides 1177″. In still other arrangements, the welds 1192″ may be more densely spaced in the center areas of the long sides 1177″ of the anvil cap 1170″.

FIG. 33 illustrates another anvil cap 1170′″ that is configured to be mechanically interlocked to the anvil body 1132′″ as well as welded to the upper body portion 1165. In this embodiment, a tongue-and-groove arrangement is employed along each long side 1177′″ of the anvil cap 1170′″. In particular, a laterally extending continuous or intermittent tab 1195′″ protrudes from each of the long sides 1177′″ of the anvil cap 1170′″. Each tab 1195″ corresponds to an axial slot 1197′″ formed in the anvil body 1132′″. The anvil cap 1170′″ is slid in from an opening in the distal end of the anvil body 1132′″ to “mechanically” affix the anvil cap to the anvil body 1132′″. The tabs 1195′″ and slots 1197′″ may be sized relative to each other to establish a sliding frictional fit therebetween. In addition, the anvil cap 1170′″ may be welded to the anvil body 1132′″. The anvil body 1132′″ and the anvil cap 1170′″ may be fabricated from metal that is conducive to welding. The weld 1178′″ may extend around the entire perimeter 1172′″ of the anvil cap 1170′″ or it may only be located along the long sides 1177′″ of the anvil cap 1170′″. The weld 1178′″ may be continuous or it may be discontinuous or intermittent. In those embodiments where the weld 1178′″ is discontinuous or intermittent, the weld segments may be equally distributed along the long sides 1177′″ of the anvil cap 1170′″ or the weld segments may be more densely spaced closer to the distal ends of the long sides 1177′″ or more densely spaced closer to the proximal ends of the long sides 1177′″. In still other arrangements, the weld segments may be more densely spaced in the center areas of the long sides 1177′″ of the anvil cap 1170′″.

The anvil embodiments described herein with anvil caps may provide several advantages. One advantage for example, may make the anvil and firing member assembly process easier. That is, the firing member may be installed through the opening in the anvil body while the anvil is attached to the elongate channel. Another advantage is that the upper cap may improve the anvil's stiffness and resistance to the above-mentioned flexure forces that may be experienced when clamping tissue. By resisting such flexure, the frictional forces normally encountered by the firing member 1660 may be reduced. Thus, the amount of firing force required to drive the firing member from its starting to ending position in the surgical staple cartridge may also be reduced.

FIG. 34 provides a side-by-side comparison of two anvils. A portion of a first anvil 2030 of an end effector 2000 is depicted in the right half of FIG. 34 and a portion of a second anvil 2030′ of an end effector 2000′ is depicted in the left half of FIG. 34 . The anvil 2030 comprises a first longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 a, a second longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 b, and a third longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 c. The anvil 2030 further comprises a longitudinal slot 2033 which is configured to receive a firing member, such as firing member 2040, for example, as the firing member is advanced through a staple firing stroke. The first longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 a is positioned intermediate the longitudinal slot 2033 and the second longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 b, and the second longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 b is positioned intermediate the first longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 a and the third longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 c. As a result, the first longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 a comprises an inner row, the third longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 c comprises an outer row, and the second longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 b comprises a middle or intermediate row.

Similar to the above, the anvil 2030′ comprises a first longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 a, a second longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 b, and a third longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 c. The anvil 2030′ further comprises a longitudinal slot 2033′ which is configured to receive a firing member, such as firing member 2040′, for example, as the firing member is advanced through a staple firing stroke. The first longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 a is positioned intermediate the longitudinal slot 2033′ and the second longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 b, and the second longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 b is positioned intermediate the first longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 a and the third longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 c. As a result, the first longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 a comprises an inner row, the third longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 c comprises an outer row, and the second longitudinal row of forming pockets 2032 b comprises a middle or intermediate row.

The anvil 2030 comprises a flat, or an at least substantially flat, tissue engaging surface 2031. The forming pockets 2032 a, 2032 b, and 2032 c are defined in the flat surface 2031. The flat surface 2031 does not have steps defined therein; however, embodiments are envisioned in which the anvil 2030 can comprise a stepped tissue engaging surface. For instance, the anvil 2030′ comprises a stepped tissue engaging surface 2031′. In this embodiment, the forming pockets 2032 a and 2032 b are defined in a lower step and the forming pockets 2032 c are defined in an upper step.

The firing member 2040′ comprises a coupling member 2042′ including a cutting portion 2041. The cutting portion 2041 is configured and arranged to incise tissue captured between the anvil 2030′ and a staple cartridge 2010 (FIG. 35 ), for example. The firing member 2040′ is configured to push a sled having inclined surfaces distally during a staple firing stroke. The inclined surfaces are configured to lift staple drivers within the staple cartridge 2010 to form staples 2020 against the anvil 2030′ and eject the staples 2020 from the staple cartridge 2010. The coupling member 2042′ comprises projections, or cams, 2043′ extending laterally therefrom which are configured to engage the anvil 2030′ during the staple firing stroke. Referring to FIG. 37 , the projections 2043′ are comprised of longitudinally elongate shoulders extending from the coupling member 2042′. In other embodiments, the projections 2043′ comprise a cylindrical pin which extends through the coupling member 2042′. In any event, the projections 2043′ have flat lateral sides, or ends, 2047′.

The longitudinal slot 2033′ comprises lateral portions 20331′ extending laterally from a central portion 2033 c′ which are configured to receive the projections 2043′. As illustrated in FIG. 34 , the lateral portions 20331′ of the longitudinal slot 2033′ have a rectangular, or at least substantially rectangular, configuration having sharp corners. Each lateral portion 20331′ of the slot 2033′ comprises a longitudinal cam surface 2035′ configured to be engaged by the projections 2043′ during the staple firing stroke. Each longitudinal cam surface 2035′ is defined on the upper side of a ledge 2037′ which extends longitudinally along the slot 2033′. Each longitudinal ledge 2037′ comprises a beam including a fixed end attached to the main body portion of the anvil 2030′ and a free end configured to move relative to the fixed end. As such, each longitudinal ledge 2037′ can comprise a cantilever beam.

The coupling member 2042′ further comprises a foot, or cam, 2044 (FIG. 35 ) configured to engage the staple cartridge 2010, or a jaw supporting the staple cartridge 2010, during the staple firing stroke. Moreover, the projections 2043′ and the foot 2044 co-operate to position the anvil 2030′ and the staple cartridge 2010 relative to one another. When the anvil 2030′ is movable relative to the staple cartridge 2010, the coupling member 2042′ can cam the anvil 2030′ into position relative to the staple cartridge 2010. When the staple cartridge 2010, or the jaw supporting the staple cartridge 2010, is movable relative to the anvil 2030′, the coupling member 2042′ can cam the staple cartridge 2010 into position relative to the anvil 2030′.

Further to the above, the firing member 2040 comprises a coupling member 2042 including a cutting portion 2041. The cutting portion 2041 is configured and arranged to incise tissue captured between the anvil 2030 and a staple cartridge 2010 (FIG. 35 ). The firing member 2040 is configured to push a sled having inclined surfaces distally during a staple firing stroke. The inclined surfaces are configured to lift staple drivers within the staple cartridge 2010 to form staples 2020 against the anvil 2030 and eject the staples 2020 from the staple cartridge 2010. The coupling member 2042 comprises projections, or cams, 2043 extending laterally therefrom which are configured to engage the anvil 2030 during the staple firing stroke. The projections 2043 have curved, or rounded, lateral sides, or ends, 2047. The lateral ends 2047 of the projections 2043 are entirely curved or fully-rounded. Each lateral end 2047 comprises an arcuate profile extending between a top surface of a projection 2043 and a bottom surface of the projection 2043. In other embodiments, the lateral ends 2047 of the projections 2043 are only partially curved.

The longitudinal slot 2033 comprises lateral portions 20331 extending laterally from a central portion 2033 c which are configured to receive the projections 2043. Each lateral portion 20331 of the slot 2033 comprises a longitudinal cam surface 2035 configured to be engaged by the projections 2043 during the staple firing stroke. Each longitudinal cam surface 2035 is defined on the upper side of a ledge 2037 which extends longitudinally along the slot 2033. Each longitudinal ledge 2037 comprises a beam including a fixed end attached to the main body portion of the anvil 2030 and a free end configured to move relative to the fixed end. As such, each longitudinal ledge 2037 can comprise a cantilever beam. As illustrated in FIG. 34 , the lateral portions of the longitudinal slot 2033 comprise a curved, or rounded, profile which match, or at least substantially match, the curved ends 2047 of the projections 2043.

The coupling member 2042 further comprises a foot, or cam, 2044 (FIG. 35 ) configured to engage the staple cartridge 2010, or a jaw supporting the staple cartridge 2010, during the staple firing stroke. Moreover, the projections 2043 and the foot 2044 co-operate to position the anvil 2030 and the staple cartridge 2010 relative to one another. When the anvil 2030 is movable relative to the staple cartridge 2010, the coupling member 2042 can cam the anvil 2030 into position relative to the staple cartridge 2010. When the staple cartridge 2010, or the jaw supporting the staple cartridge 2010, is movable relative to the anvil 2030, the coupling member 2042 can cam the staple cartridge 2010 into position relative to the anvil 2030.

Referring again to FIG. 34 , the lateral portions 20331′ of the longitudinal slot 2033′ extend a distance 2034′ from a centerline CL of the anvil 2030′. The lateral portions 20331′ extend over, or behind, the forming pockets 2032 a in the anvil 2030′. As illustrated in FIG. 34 , the lateral ends of the lateral portions 20331′ are aligned with the outer edges of the forming pockets 2032 a. Other embodiments are envisioned in which the lateral portions 20331′ extend laterally beyond the forming pockets 2032 a, for example. That said, referring to FIG. 36 , the ledges 2037′ of the anvil 2030′ are long and, in certain instances, the ledges 2037′ can deflect significantly under load. In some instances, the ledges 2037′ can deflect downwardly such that a large portion of the drive surfaces 2045′ defined on the bottom of the projections 2043′ are not in contact with the cam surfaces 2035′. In such instances, the contact between the projections 2043′ and the cam surfaces 2035′ can be reduced to a point, such as point 2047′, for example. In some instances, the contact between the projections 2043′ and the cam surfaces 2035′ can be reduced to a longitudinally extending line, which may appear to be a point when viewed from the distal end of the end effector, as illustrated in FIG. 36 .

Moreover, referring again to FIG. 34 , the projections 2043′ extend over, or behind, the forming pockets 2032 a in the anvil 2030′. The lateral ends of the projections 2043′ extend over a longitudinal centerline 2062 a of the forming pockets 2032 a. Other embodiments are envisioned in which the lateral ends of the projections 2043′ are aligned with the longitudinal centerline 2062 a of the forming pockets 2032 a. Certain embodiments are envisioned in which the lateral ends of the projections 2043′ do not extend to the longitudinal centerline 2062 a of the forming pockets 2032 a. In any event, referring again to FIG. 36 , the projections 2043′ can deflect upwardly, especially when the projections 2043′ are long, such that a large portion of the drive surfaces 2045′ of the projections 2043′ are not in contact with the cam surfaces 2035′. This condition can further exacerbate the condition discussed above in connection with the ledges 2037′. That being said, the projections 2043′ may be able to better control the staple formation process occurring in the forming pockets 2032 a, and/or the forming pockets 2032 b and 2032 c, when the projections 2043′ extend to the outer edge of the forming pockets 2032 a or beyond, for instance.

Further to the above, the ledges 2037′ and the projections 2043′ can deflect in a manner which causes the load flowing between the firing member 2040′ and the anvil 2030′ to be applied at the inner ends of ledges 2037′. As illustrated in FIG. 36 , the contact points 2048′ are at or near the inner ends of the ledges 2037′. The deflection of the ledges 2037′, and the projections 2043′, is the same or similar to that of cantilever beams. As the reader should appreciate, the deflection of a cantilever beam is proportional to the cube of the beam length when the load is applied at the end of the cantilever beam. In any event, gaps between the ledges 2037′ and the projections 2043′ can be created when the ledges 2037′ and/or the projections 2043′ deflect. Such gaps between portions of the ledges 2037′ and the projections 2043′ means that the forces flowing therebetween will flow through very small areas which will, as a result, increase the stress and strain experienced by the ledges 2037′ and projections 2043′. This interaction is represented by stress risers, or concentrations, 2039′ and 2049′ in FIGS. 38 and 39 where stress risers 2039′ are present in the ledges 2037′ and stress risers 2049′ are present at the interconnection between the projections 2043′ and the coupling member 2042′. Other stress risers, or concentrations, may be present but, as discussed below, it is desirable to reduce or eliminate such stress risers.

Referring again to FIGS. 34 and 35 , the lateral portions 20331 of the longitudinal slot 2033 each extend a distance 2034 from a centerline CL of the anvil 2030. The distance 2034 is shorter than the distance 2034′. Nonetheless, the lateral portions 20331 extend over, or behind, the forming pockets 2032 a in the anvil 2030. As illustrated in FIG. 34 , the lateral ends of the lateral portions 20331 are not aligned with the outer edges of the forming pockets 2032 a. Moreover, the lateral ends of the lateral portions 20331 do not extend beyond the outer edges of the forming pockets 2032 a; however, the lateral portions 20331 extend over the longitudinal centerlines 2062 a of the forming pockets 2032 a. Further to the above, the ledges 2037 are shorter than the ledges 2037′. As such, the ledges 2037 will experience less deflection, stress, and strain than the ledges 2037′ for a given force applied thereto.

Other embodiments are envisioned in which the lateral portions 20331 of the slot 2033 do not extend to the longitudinal centerline 2062 a of the forming pockets 2032 a. In certain embodiments, the lateral portions 20331 do not extend laterally over or overlap the forming pockets 2032 a. Such shorter lateral portions 20331, further to the above, can reduce the deflection, stress, and strain in the ledges 2037. Owing to the reduced deflection of the ledges 2037, the drive surfaces 2045 defined on the bottom of the projections 2043 can remain in contact with the cam surfaces 2035 of the ledges 2037. In such instances, the contact area between the projections 2043 and the cam surfaces 2035 can be increased as compared to the contact area between the projections 2043′ and the cam surfaces 2035′.

Further to the above, the cross-sectional thickness of the ledges 2037 isn't constant, unlike the ledges 2037′ which have a constant cross-sectional thickness. The ledges 2037 have a tapered cross-sectional thickness where the base of each ledge 2037 is wider than its inner end owing to the rounded lateral ends of the lateral slot portions 20331. Such a configuration can serve to stiffen or strengthen the ledges 2037 and reduce the deflection, stress, and strain of the ledges 2037 as compared to the ledges 2037′. In at least one instance, a portion of a ledge 2037 is tapered while another portion of the ledge 2037 has a constant cross-sectional thickness. In at least one other instance, the entirety of a ledge 2037 can be tapered such that none of the cross-sectional thickness is constant.

Moreover, referring again to FIGS. 34 and 35 , the projections 2043 extend over, or behind, the forming pockets 2032 a in the anvil 2030. The lateral ends of the projections 2043 do not extend over the longitudinal centerline 2062 a of the forming pockets 2032 a. Other embodiments are envisioned in which the lateral ends of the projections 2043 are aligned with the longitudinal centerline 2062 a of the forming pockets 2032 a. Certain embodiments are envisioned in which the lateral ends of the projections 2043 do not extend over the forming pockets 2032 a at all. In any event, the upward deflection of the projections 2043 may be less than the projections 2043′ and, as a result, a larger contact area can be present between the drive surfaces 2045 and the cam surfaces 2035.

Further to the above, the ledges 2037 and the projections 2043 can deflect in a manner which causes the load flowing between the firing member 2040 and the anvil 2030 to be applied laterally along the lengths of the ledges 2037 instead of at a single point and/or at end of the ledges 2037. As a result, the forces flowing therebetween will flow through larger areas which will, as a result, reduce the stress and strain experienced by the ledges 2037 and projections 2043 which can reduce or eliminate the stress risers discussed above in connection with the ledges 2037′ and the projections 2043′, for example.

Referring again to FIG. 35 , the foot 2044 of the coupling member 2042 is wider than the projections 2033. Stated another way, the lateral width of the foot 2044 is wider than the width between the lateral ends of the projections 2033. In such instances, the foot 2044 can deflect or strain more than the projections and, as a result, the deflection of the projections 2033 can be reduced. Alternative embodiments are envisioned in which the lateral width of the foot 2044 is the same as or less than the width between the lateral ends of the projections 2033; however, such embodiments can be otherwise configured to provide the desired deflection and/or strain within the projections 2033.

As discussed above, an end effector can comprise an anvil, for example, which is movable between an open position and a closed position. In some instances, the anvil is moved toward its closed position by a firing member, such as firing member 2040 or 2040′, for example, when the firing member is moved distally. In other instances, the anvil is moved toward its closed position prior to the firing member being advanced distally to perform a staple firing stroke. In either event, the anvil may not move into its entirely closed position until the firing member approaches or reaches the end of its staple firing stroke. As a result, the anvil is progressively closed by the firing member. In at least one such instance, the anvil may progressively close owing to thick tissue captured between the anvil and the staple cartridge. In some instances, the anvil may actually deflect or deform during the staple firing stroke of the firing member. Such circumstances are generally controlled, however, by the upper projections and the bottom foot of the firing member.

Turning now to FIG. 37 , the drive surfaces 2045′ defined on the projections 2043′ are flat, or at least substantially flat. Moreover, the drive surfaces 2045′ are configured to flushingly engage the flat, or at least substantially flat, cam surfaces 2035′ defined on the anvil 2030′ when the anvil 2030′ is in a completely closed position. Stated another way, the drive surfaces 2045′ engage the cam surfaces 2035′ in a face-to-face relationship when the anvil 2030′ is in a completely flat orientation. A flat orientation of the anvil 2030′ is depicted in phantom in FIG. 37 . In such instances, the drive surfaces 2045′ are parallel, or at least substantially parallel, to the longitudinal path of the firing member 2040′ during the staple firing stroke. As discussed above, however, the anvil 2030′ may progressively close during the firing stroke and, as a result, the anvil 2030′ may not always be in an entirely closed position. As a result, the drive surfaces 2045′ may not always be aligned with the cam surfaces 2035′ and, in such instances, the projections 2043′ may gouge into the ledges 2037′ of the anvil 2030. FIG. 37 depicts such instances with solid lines.

Further to the above, the drive surfaces 2045′ of the projections 2043′ and/or the cam surfaces 2035′ defined on the ledges 2037′ can plastically deform if the firing member 2040′ has to progressively close the anvil 2030′ into its entirely closed position. In certain instances, the cam surfaces 2035′ can gall, for example, which can increase the force needed to complete the staple firing stroke. More specifically, plastic strain of the projections 2043′ and/or the anvil ledges 2037′ can cause energy losses as the metal is deformed beyond the plastic limits. At that point, galling occurs and the frictional co-efficient of the coupling increases substantially. The energy losses can be in the order of about 10%-30%, for example, which can increase the force needed to fire the firing member in the order of about 10%-30%. Moreover, the force needed to complete subsequent staple firing strokes with the end effector 2000′ may increase in such instances in the event that the end effector 2000′ is reused.

Turning now to FIGS. 40-42 , a firing member 2140 comprises a firing bar and a coupling member 2142 attached to the firing bar. The coupling member 2142 comprises a connector 2148 which connects the coupling member 2142 to the firing bar. The coupling member 2142 further comprises a cutting member 2041 configured to incise the tissue of a patient during a staple firing stroke. The coupling member 2142 also comprises projections 2143 configured to engage an anvil, such as anvil 2030 or 2030′, for example, and, in addition, a foot 2144 configured to engage a staple cartridge jaw during the staple firing stroke. Each projection 2143 comprises a drive surface 2145 defined on the bottom side thereof. Each projection 2143 further comprises a proximally-extending cam transition 2147 and a radiused-transition 2149 extending around the perimeter of the projection 2143. The coupling member 2142 further comprises intermediate projections 2146 extending laterally therefrom which are configured to prevent the firing member 2140 from performing the staple firing stroke when an unspent staple cartridge is not positioned in front of the firing member 2140 at the outset of the staple firing stroke.

Further to the above, the drive surfaces 2145 of the projections 2143 are not parallel to the longitudinal path 2160 of the firing member 2140. Rather, the drive surfaces 2145 extend transversely to the longitudinal path 2160. In at least one instance, the distal end of each drive surface 2145 is positioned further away from the longitudinal path 2160 than the proximal end. Such an arrangement can reduce or eliminate the problems described above in connection with the progressive closure of the anvil 2130. More specifically, in at least one instance, if the anvil 2130 will move through a range of motion between about 4 degrees and about 0 degrees with respect to the longitudinal path 2160 during the progressive closure, then the drive surface 2145 could be oriented at about 2 degrees with respect to the longitudinal path 2160, for example, which represents the midpoint in the range of progressive closure. Other embodiments are possible. For instance, if the anvil 2130 will move through a range of motion between about 1 degree and about 0 degrees with respect to the longitudinal path 2160 during the progressive closure, then the drive surfaces 2145 could be oriented at about 1 degree with respect to the longitudinal path 2160, for example, which represents the upper bound in the range of progressive closure. In various instances, the firing member 2140 may be required to progressively close the anvil 2130 through a 5 degree range of motion, for example. In other instances, the firing member 2140 may be required to progressively the anvil 2130 through a 10 degree range of motion, for example. In some instances, the anvil 2130 may not reach its completely closed position and, as a result, the progressive closure of the anvil 2130 may not reach 0 degrees.

Further to the above, the drive surface 2145 of the projection 2143 is not parallel to the drive surface of the foot 2144. Referring primarily to FIG. 41 , the drive surface 2145 extends along an axis 2183 and the drive surface of the foot 2144 extends along an axis 2184. In at least one instance, the drive surface 2145 is oriented at an about 0.5 degree angle with respect to the drive surface of the foot 2144, for example. Other instances are envisioned in which the drive surface 2145 is oriented at an about 1 degree angle with respect to the drive surface of the foot 2144, for example. Certain instances are envisioned in which the drive surface 2145 is oriented between about 0.5 degrees and about 5 degrees with respect to the drive surface of the foot 2144, for example. The drive surface of the foot 2144 is parallel to the longitudinal path 2160; however, other embodiments are envisioned in which the drive surface of the foot 2144 is not parallel to the longitudinal path 2160.

The examples provided above were discussed in connection with a movable anvil; however, it should be understood that the teachings of such examples could be adapted to any suitable movable jaw, such as a movable staple cartridge jaw, for example. Similarly, the examples provided elsewhere in this application could be adapted to any movable jaw.

Turning now to FIGS. 43-45 , a firing member 2240 comprises a firing bar and a coupling member 2242 attached to the firing bar. The coupling member 2242 comprises a connector 2148 which connects the coupling member 2242 to the firing bar. The coupling member 2242 further comprises a cutting member 2041 configured to incise the tissue of a patient during a staple firing stroke. The coupling member 2242 also comprises projections 2243 configured to engage an anvil, such as anvil 2030 or 2030′, for example, and, in addition, a foot 2144 configured to engage a staple cartridge jaw during the staple firing stroke. Each projection 2243 comprises a drive surface 2245 defined on the bottom side thereof. Each projection 2243 further comprises a radiused-transition 2249 extending around the perimeter thereof. The coupling member 2242 further comprises intermediate projections 2146 extending laterally therefrom which are configured to prevent the firing member 2240 from performing the staple firing stroke when an unspent staple cartridge is not positioned in front of the firing member 2240 at the outset of the staple firing stroke.

Further to the above, each projection 2243 comprises a leading, or proximal, end 2251 configured to engage the anvil and, in addition, a trailing end. The leading end of each projection 2243 is different than the lagging, or trailing, end of the projection 2243. The leading end 2251 comprises a radius which extends from the bottom drive surface 2245 of the projection 2243 to a location positioned above a longitudinal centerline 2250 of the projection 2243. The leading end 2251 comprises a single radius of curvature; however, the leading end 2251 can be comprised of more than one radius of curvature. Each projection 2243 further comprises a radiused edge 2259 between the radiused leading end 2251 and the top surface of the projection 2243. The radius of curvature of the edge 2259 is smaller than the radius of curvature of the leading end 2251. Other embodiments are envisioned in which the entirety of, or at least a portion of, the leading end 2251 is linear. In any event, the configuration of the leading end 2251 can shift the force, or load, transmitted between the firing member 2240 and the anvil away from the leading end 2251 toward the trailing end of the projection 2243. Stated another way, the configuration of the leading end 2251 may prevent the leading end 2251 from becoming the focal point of the transmitted force between the firing member 2240 and the anvil. Such an arrangement can prevent or reduce the possibility of the firing member 2240 becoming stuck against the anvil and can reduce the force required to move the firing member 2240 distally.

Turning now to FIGS. 46-48 , a firing member 2340 comprises a firing bar and a coupling member 2342 attached to the firing bar. The coupling member 2342 comprises a connector 2148 which connects the coupling member 2342 to the firing bar. The coupling member 2342 further comprises a cutting member 2041 configured to incise the tissue of a patient during a staple firing stroke. The coupling member 2342 also comprises projections 2343 configured to engage an anvil, such as anvil 2030 or 2030′, for example, and, in addition, a foot 2144 configured to engage a staple cartridge jaw during the staple firing stroke. Each projection 2343 comprises a drive surface defined on the bottom side thereof. Each projection 2343 further comprises a radiused-transition 2349 extending around the perimeter thereof. The coupling member 2342 further comprises intermediate projections 2146 extending laterally therefrom which are configured to prevent the firing member 2340 from performing the staple firing stroke when an unspent staple cartridge is not positioned in front of the firing member 2340 at the outset of the staple firing stroke.

Further to the above, each projection 2343 comprises a radiused leading end 2351. The leading end 2351 is similar to the leading end 2251 and comprises a curved surface which extends across the centerline 2350 of the projection 2343. The leading end 2251 has a different configuration than the trailing end of the projection 2243. Each projection 2343 further comprises a lateral side, or end, 2352. Each lateral end 2352 comprises a flat surface which is positioned intermediate radiused, or curved, edges 2347. A first radiused edge 2347 is positioned intermediate a top surface of the projection 2343 and the lateral end 2352 and, in addition, a second radiused edge 2347 is positioned intermediate a bottom surface of the projection 2343 and the lateral end 2352.

Turning now to FIGS. 49-51 , a firing member 2440 comprises a firing bar and a coupling member 2442 attached to the firing bar. The coupling member 2442 comprises a connector 2148 which connects the coupling member 2442 to the firing bar. The coupling member 2442 further comprises a cutting member 2041 configured to incise the tissue of a patient during a staple firing stroke. The coupling member 2442 also comprises projections 2443 configured to engage an anvil, such as anvil 2030 or 2030′, for example, and, in addition, a foot 2144 configured to engage a staple cartridge jaw during the staple firing stroke. Each projection 2443 comprises a drive surface 2445 defined on the bottom side thereof. Each projection 2443 further comprises a radiused-transition extending around the perimeter thereof. The coupling member 2442 further comprises intermediate projections 2146 extending laterally therefrom which are configured to prevent the firing member 2440 from performing the staple firing stroke when an unspent staple cartridge is not positioned in front of the firing member 2440 at the outset of the staple firing stroke.

Further to the above, the lateral sides, or ends, of each projection 2443 are defined by more than one radius of curvature. Each projection 2443 comprises a first radius of curvature 2447 a extending from the bottom drive surface 2445 and a second radius of curvature 2447 b extending from the top surface of the projection 2443. The first radius of curvature 2447 a is different than the second radius of curvature 2447 b. For instance, the first radius of curvature 2447 a is larger than the second radius of curvature 2447 b; however, the curvatures 2447 a and 2447 b can comprise any suitable configuration. Referring primarily to FIG. 51 , the first radius of curvature 2447 a extends upwardly past a centerline 2450 of the projection 2443.

Turning now to FIGS. 52-54 , a firing member 2540 comprises a firing bar and a coupling member 2542 attached to the firing bar. The coupling member 2542 comprises a connector 2148 which connects the coupling member 2542 to the firing bar. The coupling member 2542 further comprises a cutting member 2041 configured to incise the tissue of a patient during a staple firing stroke. The coupling member 2542 also comprises projections 2543 configured to engage an anvil, such as anvil 2030 or 2030′, for example, and, in addition, a foot 2144 configured to engage a staple cartridge jaw during the staple firing stroke. Each projection 2543 comprises a drive surface defined on the bottom side thereof. Each projection 2543 further comprises a radiused-transition extending around the perimeter thereof. The coupling member 2542 further comprises intermediate projections 2146 extending laterally therefrom which are configured to prevent the firing member 2540 from performing the staple firing stroke when an unspent staple cartridge is not positioned in front of the firing member 2540 at the outset of the staple firing stroke.

Further to the above, each projection 2543 comprises a lateral side, or end, 2552 which is flat, or at least substantially flat. Each projection 2543 further comprises a radiused transition 2547 extending around the lateral end 2552. Each projection 2543 is symmetrical, or at least substantially symmetrical, about a longitudinal centerline which extends through the lateral end 2552. Moreover, the top surface and the bottom surface of each projection 2543 are parallel to one another.

Referring primarily to FIG. 53 , the leading end 2551 of each projection 2543 is positioned distally with respect to a cutting edge 2042 of the cutting portion 2041. The trailing end 2559 of each projection 2543 is positioned proximally with respect to the cutting edge 2042. As a result, the projections 2043 longitudinally span the cutting edge 2042. In such instances, the firing member 2540 can hold the anvil and the staple cartridge together directly at the location in which the tissue is being cut.

Turning now to FIGS. 55-57 , a firing member 2640 comprises a firing bar and a coupling member 2642 attached to the firing bar. The coupling member 2642 comprises a connector 2148 which connects the coupling member 2642 to the firing bar. The coupling member 2642 further comprises a cutting member 2041 configured to incise the tissue of a patient during a staple firing stroke. The coupling member 2642 also comprises projections 2643 configured to engage an anvil, such as anvil 2030 or 2030′, for example, and, in addition, a foot 2144 configured to engage a staple cartridge jaw during the staple firing stroke. Each projection 2643 comprises a drive surface 2645 defined on the bottom side thereof. Each projection 2643 further comprises a radiused-transition 2649 extending around the perimeter thereof. The coupling member 2642 further comprises intermediate projections 2146 extending laterally therefrom which are configured to prevent the firing member 2640 from performing the staple firing stroke when an unspent staple cartridge is not positioned in front of the firing member 2640 at the outset of the staple firing stroke.

Further to the above, each projection 2643 further comprises a lateral end 2652, a bottom drive surface 2645, and a top surface 2647. The bottom drive surface 2645 is flat and is parallel to the longitudinal firing path 2660 of the firing member 2640. Referring primarily to FIG. 57 , the top surface 2647 is flat, but not parallel to the longitudinal firing path 2660. Moreover, the top surface 2647 is not parallel to the bottom surface 2645. As a result, each projection 2643 is asymmetrical. In fact, the orientation of the top surface 2647 shifts the moment of inertia of the projection 2643 above the lateral end 2652. Such an arrangement can increase the bending stiffness of the projections 2643 which can reduce the deflection of the projections 2643.

Turning now to FIGS. 58-60 , a firing member 2740 comprises a firing bar and a coupling member 2742 attached to the firing bar. The coupling member 2742 comprises a connector 2148 which connects the coupling member 2742 to the firing bar. The coupling member 2742 further comprises a cutting member 2041 configured to incise the tissue of a patient during a staple firing stroke. The coupling member 2742 also comprises projections 2743 configured to engage an anvil, such as anvil 2030 or 2030′, for example, and, in addition, a foot 2144 configured to engage a staple cartridge jaw during the staple firing stroke. Each projection 2743 comprises a drive surface defined on the bottom side thereof. The coupling member 2742 further comprises intermediate projections 2146 extending laterally therefrom which are configured to prevent the firing member 2740 from performing the staple firing stroke when an unspent staple cartridge is not positioned in front of the firing member 2740 at the outset of the staple firing stroke.

Further to the above, each projection 2743 comprises a first, or leading, portion 2753 a and a second, or lagging, portion 2753 b positioned distally behind the leading portion 2753 a. The leading portion 2753 a comprises a curved lead-in surface 2751 defined on the distal end thereof which is configured to initially engage the anvil. The leading portion 2753 a further comprises a first, or leading, drive surface 2745 a defined on the bottom side thereof. Similarly, the lagging portion 2753 b comprises a second, or lagging, drive surface 2745 b defined on the bottom side thereof. Each projection 2743 further comprises a transition 2752 defined between the leading portion 2753 a and the lagging portion 2753 b.

As the firing member 2740 is advanced distally, further to the above, the drive surfaces 2745 a and 2745 b can co-operate to engage and position the anvil. In certain embodiments, the drive surfaces 2745 a and 2745 b define a drive plane which is parallel, or at least substantially parallel, to the longitudinal path 2760 of the firing member 2740 during the staple firing stroke. In some instances, however, only the leading drive surface 2745 a may engage the cam surface defined on the anvil. Such instances can arise when the firing member 2740 progressively closes the anvil, for example.

In other embodiments, referring to FIGS. 69 and 71 , the leading drive surface 2745 a is positioned above the lagging drive surface 2745 b. Stated another way, the leading drive surface 2745 a is positioned further away from the longitudinal path 2760 than the lagging drive surface 2745 b such that both drive surfaces 2745 a and 2745 b remain in contact with the anvil during the staple firing stroke. In at least one instance, the drive surfaces 2745 a and 2745 b can define a drive plane which is transverse to the longitudinal path 2760. In certain instances, a 1 degree angle, for example, can be defined between the drive plane and the longitudinal path 2760. In various instances, the leading drive surface 2745 a is positioned vertically above the lagging drive surface 2745 b by approximately 0.001″, for example. In other embodiments, the leading drive surface 2745 a is positioned vertically above the lagging drive surface 2745 b by approximately 0.002″, for example. In certain instances, the leading drive surface 2745 a is positioned above the lagging drive surface 2745 b a distance which is between about 0.001″ and about 0.002″, for example

In certain instances, referring again to FIG. 70 , only the lagging drive surfaces 2745 b may be in contact with the cam surfaces of the anvil when the firing member 2740 progressively closes the anvil. In such instances, the leading drive surfaces 2745 a are not in contact with the cam surfaces of the anvil. Such an arrangement can reduce the plastic deformation of the projections 2743 and reduce to force needed to advance the firing member 2740 distally as compared to when only the leading drive surfaces 2745 a are in contact with the cam surfaces of the anvil. When the anvil begins to flex owing to the staple forming load being applied to the anvil, in some instances, the anvil can flex upwardly into contact with the leasing drive surfaces 2745 a as illustrated in FIG. 71 .

The leading portion 2753 a is thicker than the lagging portion 2753 b. Stated another way, the leading portion 2753 a has a larger bending moment of inertia than the lagging portion 2753 b which can resist the upward bending of the projection 2743. As a result, the lagging portion 2753 b can deflect upwardly more than the leading portion 2753 a. In such instances, it is more likely that both portions 2753 a and 2753 b of the projections 2743 can remain in contact with the anvil during the staple firing stroke even though the firing member 2740 is being used to progressively close the anvil. Moreover, the leading portion 2753 a also has a larger shear thickness than the lagging portion 2753 b which can better resist shear forces transmitted through the projections 2743. The leading portion 2753 a is often exposed to greater shear forces than the lagging portion 2753 b and, as a result, can benefit from the increased shear thickness. If it is believed that the lagging portion 2753 b may experience greater shear forces than the leading projection 2753 a, then the lagging portion 2753 b can have a greater shear thickness than the leading portion 2753 a, for example.

Turning now to FIGS. 61-63 , a firing member 2840 comprises a firing bar and a coupling member 2842 attached to the firing bar. The coupling member 2842 comprises a connector 2148 which connects the coupling member 2842 to the firing bar. The coupling member 2842 further comprises a cutting member 2041 configured to incise the tissue of a patient during a staple firing stroke. The coupling member 2842 also comprises projections configured to engage an anvil, such as anvil 2030 or 2030′, for example, and, in addition, a foot 2144 configured to engage a staple cartridge jaw during the staple firing stroke. As described in greater detail below, each projection comprises a drive surface defined on the bottom side thereof. The coupling member 2842 further comprises intermediate projections 2146 extending laterally therefrom which are configured to prevent the firing member 2840 from performing the staple firing stroke when an unspent staple cartridge is not positioned in front of the firing member 2840 at the outset of the staple firing stroke.

Further to the above, each side of the coupling member comprises a first, or leading, projection 2843 d and a second, or lagging, projection 2843 p positioned behind the leading projection 2843 d. The leading projection 2843 d comprises a curved lead-in surface 2851 d defined on the distal end thereof which is configured to initially engage the anvil. The leading projection 2843 d further comprises a first, or leading, drive surface 2845 d defined on the bottom side thereof. Similarly, the lagging projection 2843 p comprises a curved lead-in surface 2851 p defined on the distal end thereof which is configured to engage the anvil. The lagging projection 2843 p further comprises a second, or lagging, drive surface 2845 p defined on the bottom side thereof.

As the firing member 2840 is advanced distally, further to the above, the drive surfaces 2845 d and 2845 p can co-operate to engage and position the anvil. In certain embodiments, the drive surfaces 2845 d and 2845 p define a drive plane which is parallel, or at least substantially parallel, to the longitudinal path 2860 of the firing member 2840 during the staple firing stroke. In other embodiments, the leading drive surface 2845 d is positioned above the lagging drive surface 2845 p. Stated another way, the leading drive surface 2845 d is positioned further away from the longitudinal path 2860 than the lagging drive surface 2845 p. In at least one instance, the drive surfaces 2845 d and 2845 p can define a drive plane which is transverse to the longitudinal path 2860. In certain instances, a 1 degree angle, for example, can be defined between the drive plane and the longitudinal path 2860.

Further to the above, the leading projections 2843 d and the lagging projections 2843 p can move relative to each other. In various instances, a leading projection 2843 d and a lagging projection 2843 p on one side of the coupling member 2842 can move independently of one another. Such an arrangement can allow the projections 2843 d and 2843 p to independently adapt to the orientation of the anvil, especially when the firing member 2840 is used to progressively close the anvil. As a result, both of the projections 2843 d and 2843 p can remain engaged with the anvil such that forces flow between the firing member 2840 and the anvil at several locations and that the plastic deformation of the projections is reduced.

FIG. 68 depicts the energy required for a first firing member to complete a firing stroke, labeled as 2090′, and a second firing member to complete a firing stroke, labeled as 3090. The firing stroke 2090′ represents a condition in which significant plastic deformation and galling is occurring. The firing stroke 3090 represents an improvement over the firing stroke 2090′ in which the deformation of the firing member and anvil ledge is mostly elastic. It is believed that, in certain instances, the plastic strain experienced by the firing member and/or anvil can be reduced by about 40%-60%, for example, by employing the teachings disclosed herein.

The various embodiments described herein can be utilized to balance the loads transmitted between a firing member and an anvil. Such embodiments can also be utilized to balance the loads transmitted between a firing member and a staple cartridge jaw. In either event, the firing member can be designed to provide a desired result but it should be understood that such a desired result may not be achieved in some circumstances owing to manufacturing tolerances of the stapling instrument and/or the variability of the tissue thickness captured within the end effector, for example. In at least one instance, the upper projections and/or the bottom foot of the firing member, for example, can comprise wearable features which are configured to allow the firing member to define a balanced interface with the anvil.

Further to the above, referring now to FIGS. 64-67 , a firing member 2940 comprises lateral projections 2943. Each projection 2943 comprises longitudinal ridges 2945 extending from the bottom thereof. The ridges 2945 are configured to plastically deform and/or smear when the firing member 2940 is advanced distally to engage the anvil. The ridges 2945 are configured to quickly wear in, or take a set, so as to increase the contact area between the projections 2943 and the anvil and provide better load balancing between the firing member 2940 and the anvil. Such an arrangement can be especially useful when the end effector is used to perform several staple firing strokes. In addition to or in lieu of the above, one or more wearable pads can be attached to the projections of the firing member which can be configured to plastically deform.

FIGS. 72 and 73 depict a surgical stapling anvil, or anvil jaw, 3100 for use with a surgical stapling instrument. The anvil 3100 is configured to deform staples during a surgical stapling procedure. The anvil 3100 comprises an anvil body 3101 and an anvil cap 3110. The anvil body 3101 and the anvil cap 3110 are welded together. The anvil body 3101 comprises a proximal portion 3102 comprising a coupling portion 3103. The coupling portion 3103 is configured to be assembled to an end effector of a surgical stapling instrument to permit rotation of the anvil jaw 3000 relative to a corresponding jaw such as, for example, a staple cartridge jaw. Embodiments are envisioned where the anvil jaw is fixed relative to the staple cartridge jaw and, in such instances, the staple cartridge jaw can rotate relative to the anvil jaw. The anvil body 3101 further comprises a distal tip portion 3104, outer edges 3107, and a planar, tissue-facing surface 3106. The tissue-facing surface 3106 comprises staple-forming pockets defined therein configured to deform staples during a surgical stapling procedure. The anvil body 3101 further comprises a longitudinal cavity, or aperture, 3105 configured to receive the anvil cap 3110 therein. As discussed in greater detail below, the longitudinal cavity 3105 can comprise corresponding surfaces configured to mate with corresponding surfaces of the anvil cap 3110 during assembly. Certain surfaces may be configured for welding while others may be configured only for alignment during assembly.

The anvil cap 3110 comprises a proximal end 3111, a distal end 3112, and a continuous perimeter, or edge, 3113. When the anvil body 3101 and the anvil cap 3110 are assembled and/or welded together, the edge 3113 may be flush, or substantially flush, with the top surface 3108 of the anvil body 3101 so as to provide a smooth upper surface of the surgical stapling anvil 3100 although a step in the seam therebetween may be possible. Further to the above, the anvil cap 3110 comprises a rounded upper surface 3114. The upper surface 3114 can be contoured and/or rounded, for example, in order to provide a continuous, curved upper surface of the surgical stapling anvil 3100 when the anvil body 3101 and the anvil cap 3110 are welded together. In various instances, the continuous edge 3113 is a feature configured for welding, as discussed below.

The two-piece surgical stapling anvil 3100 can permit the polishing of internal surfaces within the anvil 3100 during manufacturing. Manufacturing these parts can include processes resulting in a less than desirable surface finish of various surfaces within the anvil. Improving the finish of various internal surfaces can reduce internal frictional forces between the anvil and a staple firing member passing therethrough. Reducing the internal frictional forces can reduce the force required for the firing member to move through its staple-firing stroke. Reducing the force required for a firing member to move through its staple-firing stroke can result in the reduction of the size of certain components resulting in the reduction of overall instrument size which is desirable. Such an arrangement can also reduce the number of instances of instrument failure. That said, there are challenges to a two-piece welded anvil. For example, a two-piece welded anvil may deflect more than a unitary anvil in some instances. In other words, a two-piece anvil may be less stiff than a unitary anvil and less resistant to bending. In addition, lateral deflection, or rotation, of the sides of an anvil away from a firing member or longitudinal instrument axis can cause staples to deform improperly. Such deflection can result in a vertical expansion of the overall system resulting formed staples with a formed height which is not the intended formed height. Moreover, such deflection may permit a firing member to vertically tear through an anvil of which it is camming. Also, transverse deflection, or rotation, may require more firing force to be applied to the firing member complete its firing stroke. For example, the distal portion of an anvil may deflect away from the staple cartridge due to the application of tissue-induced pressure. Minimizing this deflection can be important to create properly formed staples. The above being said, the presence of both transverse and lateral deflection can have a compounding effect. In fact, transverse deflection can induce lateral deflection of the anvil.

FIG. 74 depicts a portion of a surgical stapling anvil 3200 comprising an anvil body 3210 and an anvil cap 3220 welded to the anvil body 3210 with a weld 3201. Although only a portion of the surgical stapling anvil 3200 is illustrated, it should be understood that a mirrored portion of the illustrated portion exists to complete the surgical stapling anvil 3200. The illustrated and mirrored portions will be discussed concurrently going forward. The anvil body 3210 comprises a tissue-facing surface 3211 comprising a plurality of staple-forming pockets 3212 defined therein, ledges 3215 comprising camming surfaces 3216 configured the be contacted by the anvil-camming features of a firing member of a surgical stapling instrument, and a longitudinal slot 3213 configured to receive the firing member therethrough. The anvil body 3210 further comprises outer edges 3214. The ledges 3215 are configured to bear, or support, a distributed load force 3231 applied by a firing member as the firing member moves through a staple-firing stroke. The anvil body 3210 further comprises a ledge 3217 configured to hold the anvil cap 3220 during welding. The ledge 3217 can aid in assembly and can ensure the proper alignment of the anvil cap 3220 and the anvil body 3210. The ledge 3217 can also act as a feature to improve overall anvil stiffness. The anvil cap 3220 comprises an upper portion 3223, a lower portion 3221, and a ledge 3224 configured to rest on the ledge 3217 before, during, and after welding.

The upper portion 3223 of the anvil cap 3220 and the anvil body 3210 are welded together with the weld 3201. Welding access is provided by beveled edges on one or both of the anvil body 3210 and the anvil cap 3220. In this instance, the weld surfaces of the anvil body 3210 and the anvil cap 3220 are vertical and, as a result, the weld 3201 is vertical. The weld 3201 comprises a weld length, or depth, labeled by 3202. The weld depth 3202 is about 0.030 inches, for example. Notably, the weld 3201 does not penetrate the anvil 3200 to the horizontal surfaces of the ledges 3217, 3224. With this arrangement, the anvil body 3210 will tend to rotationally deflect about the pivot axis P owing to the combination of forces applied to the anvil body 3210 by the firing member and the tissue. As the firing member cams the surfaces 3216 by pressing on the ledges 3215, represented by distributed load force 3231, and the tissue and the cartridge push on the tissue-facing surface 3211, represented by distributed load force 3232, both sides of the anvil body 3210 (only one shown in FIG. 74 ) may tend to rotate about a pivot axis P and deflect vertically and/or outwardly with respect to the firing member and the anvil cap 3220. This deflection, represented by deflection 3233, is permitted due to the lack of weld penetration from the provided weld arrangement. In some instances, the anvil body 3210 and the anvil cap 3220 may spread apart at an non-welded portion, or seam, 3204 having a length 3203.

FIG. 75 depicts a portion of a surgical stapling anvil 3300 comprising an anvil body 3310 and an anvil cap 3320 welded to the anvil body 3310 with a weld 3301. Although only a portion of the surgical stapling anvil 3300 is illustrated, it should be understood that a mirrored portion of the illustrated portion exists to complete the surgical stapling anvil 3300. The illustrated and mirrored portions will be discussed concurrently going forward. The anvil body 3310 comprises a tissue-facing surface 3311 comprising a plurality of staple-forming pockets 3312 defined therein, ledges 3315 comprising camming surfaces 3316 configured to be contacted by the anvil-camming features of a firing member of a surgical stapling instrument, and a longitudinal slot 3313 configured to receive a firing member therethrough. The anvil body 3310 further comprises outer edges 3314. The ledges 3315 are configured to bear, or support, a distributed load force 3331 applied by the firing member as the firing member moves through a staple-firing stroke. The anvil body 3310 further comprises an upper portion 3317 extending from the slot 3313 to the outer edge 3314. The anvil cap 3320 comprises an upper portion 3323, a lower portion 3321, and a ledge 3224 configured to rest on the upper portion 3317 before, during, and after welding.

The ledge 3324 of the anvil cap 3320 and the upper portion 3317 of the anvil body 3310 are welded together with the weld 3301. Welding access is provided by a beveled edge of the anvil cap 3320. In this instance, the weld surfaces of the anvil body 3310 and the anvil cap 3320 are horizontal and, as a result, the weld 3301 is horizontal. The weld 3301 comprises a weld length, or depth, labeled by 3302. The weld depth 3302 is about 0.030 inches, for example. Such a weld depth 3302, however, creates a non-welded portion 3304 having a non-welded width 3303. The non-welded width is about 0.080 inches, for example. With this arrangement, the anvil body 3310 will tend to rotationally deflect about the pivot axis P and the upper portion 3317 and the ledge 3324 will tend to compress during deflection. However, a non-welded width 3303 extends between the slot 3313 and beyond the second row of staple-forming pockets 3312. In various instances, the combination of forces applied to the anvil body 3310 by the firing member and the tissue can generate a deflection indicated by deflection 3333. As the firing member cams the anvil 3300 toward the opposing staple cartridge by pressing on the ledges 3315, represented by distributed load force 3331, and as the tissue and the staple cartridge push on the tissue-facing surface 3311, represented by distributed load force 3332, both sides of the anvil body 3310 (only one shown in FIG. 75 ) may tend to rotate and deflect vertically and/or outwardly with respect to the firing member. This deflection 3333 occurs due to the lack of weld penetration, the significant non-welded width 3304, as well as the horizontal weld arrangement 3301.

FIG. 76 depicts a portion of a surgical stapling anvil 3400 comprising an anvil body 3410 and an anvil cap 3420 welded to the anvil body 3410 with a weld 3401. Although only a portion of the surgical stapling anvil 3400 is illustrated, it should be understood that a mirrored portion of the illustrated portion exists to complete the surgical stapling anvil 3400. The illustrated and mirrored portions will be discussed concurrently going forward. The anvil body 3410 comprises a tissue-facing surface 3411 comprising a plurality of staple-forming pockets 3412 defined therein, ledges 3415 comprising camming surfaces 3416 configured to be contacted by the anvil-camming features of a firing member of a surgical stapling instrument, and a longitudinal slot 3413 configured to receive the firing member therethrough. The anvil body 3410 further comprises outer edges 3414. The ledges 3415 are configured to bear, or support, a distributed load force 3431 applied by the firing member as the firing member moves through a staple-firing stroke. The anvil body 3410 further comprises a ledge 3417 configured to hold the anvil cap 3420 during welding. The ledge 3417 can aid in assembling the cap 3420 and the body 3410 and can ensure the proper alignment of the anvil cap 3420 and the anvil body 3410. The ledge 3417 can also improve the overall anvil stiffness of the anvil 3400. The anvil cap 3420 comprises an upper portion 3423, a lower portion 3421, and a ledge 3424 configured to rest on the ledge 3417 before, during, and after welding.

The upper portion 3423 of the anvil cap 3420 and the anvil body 3410 are welded together with the weld 3401. Welding access is provided by beveled edges of on or both of the anvil body 3410 and the anvil cap 3420. In this instance, the weld surfaces of the anvil body 3410 and the anvil cap 3420 are angled and, as a result, the weld 3401 is angled. The weld 3401 comprises a weld length, or depth, labeled by 3402. The weld depth 3402 is about 0.030 inches, for example. Notably, the weld 3401 does not penetrate the anvil 3400 to the horizontal surfaces of the ledges 3417, 3424 and, with this arrangement, the anvil body 3410 will tend to rotationally deflect about the pivot axis P. Specifically, the combination of forces applied to the anvil body 3410 by the firing member and the tissue can generate deflection represented by deflection 3433. As the firing member cams the anvil 3400 toward the opposing staple cartridge by pressing on the ledges 3415, represented by distributed load force 3431, and the tissue and the staple cartridge push on the tissue-facing surface 3411, represented by distributed load force 3432, both sides of the anvil body 3410 (only one shown in FIG. 76 ) may tend to rotate about the pivot axis P. However, the angled weld surfaces will tend to compress as both sides of the anvil body 3410 rotate which may limit the amount of deflection that the anvil 3400 experiences. The anvil body 3410 and the anvil cap 3420 may tend to compress at a non-welded portion 3404 having a length 3403, resulting in a very strong interconnection between the cap 3420 and the body 3410.

FIG. 77 depicts a surgical stapling anvil 3500 for use with a surgical stapling instrument. The anvil 3500 comprises an anvil body 3510 and an anvil cap 3520. The anvil body 3510 comprises a tissue-facing surface 3511 comprising a plurality of staple-forming pockets 3512 defined therein, ledges 3515 comprising camming surfaces 3516 configured to be engaged by anvil-camming features of a firing member of the surgical stapling instrument, and a longitudinal slot 3513 configured to receive a firing member therethrough. The ledges 3415 are configured to bear, or support, a distributed load force applied by a firing member as the firing member moves through a staple-firing stroke. The anvil body 3510 further comprises ledges 3517 configured to hold the anvil cap 3520 in place during welding. The ledge 3517 can aid in assembling the cap 3520 and the anvil body 3510 and can ensure the proper alignment of the anvil cap 3520 and the anvil body 3510. The ledge 3517 can also improve the overall stiffness of the anvil 3500. The anvil cap 3520 comprises an upper portion 3523, a lower portion 3521, and ledges 3524 configured to rest on the ledges 3517 before, during, and after welding.

The upper portion 3523 of the anvil cap 3520 and the anvil body 3510 are welded together with welds 3501. Only one weld 3501 is illustrated to provide clarity of the relationship of the anvil body 3510 and the anvil cap 3520 before and after welding. In this instance, the weld surfaces of the anvil body 3510 and the anvil cap 3520 are angled and, as a result, the welds 3501 are angled. Each weld 3501 comprises a weld length, or depth, labeled by 3502. The weld depth, or penetration, 3502 can be between about 0.015 inches and about 0.040 inches. In certain instances, the weld depth is 0.030 inches, for example. Notably, the welds 3501 penetrate the anvil 3500 to the horizontal surfaces of the ledges 3517, 3524. Providing angled weld surfaces that are configured to match weld penetration depth can aid in preventing anvil deflection rotationally as well as vertically. In other words, having welds with a weld penetration depth equal to or greater than that of the length of the angled weld surfaces can increase the moment of inertia and the overall stiffness of the anvil 3500. In other instances, the weld depth 3502 may be less than the length of the angled weld surfaces, or mated length. Suitable welding techniques are used to weld any of the anvils disclosed herein. In some instances a gap is present between adjacent weld surfaces which is configured to receive weld material. In some instances, a gap is not provided. In at least one such instance, the angled weld surfaces are laser welded.

FIG. 78 is a micrograph of an anvil 3600 comprising an anvil body portion 3610 and an upper anvil portion 3620. The anvil body portion 3610 comprises a tissue-facing surface 3611 comprising a plurality of staple forming pockets 3612 defined therein, a longitudinal cavity 3613 configured to receive a firing member of a surgical instrument therethrough, and ledges 3615 configured to be engaged by a firing member during a staple firing stroke. The anvil body portion 3610 and the upper anvil portion 3620 are welded to each other with welds 3601—each comprising a weld penetration length 3602. Notably, the welds 3601 do not penetrate the anvil 3600 to the horizontal surfaces 3617 of the upper ledges 3616 of the anvil body portion 3610.

The anvil 3600 comprises a massive non-welded width 3606 and, also, a massive a slot cavity width 3605. The non-welded width 3606 is about 125% of the cavity width 3605. The non-welded width 3606 is so wide, in fact, that the intermediate forming pocket rows 3612B and the inner forming pocket rows 3612A are defined within the non-welded width 3606. Similarly, the inner forming pockets 3612A and a portion of the intermediate forming pockets 3612B are defined with the slot cavity width 3605. Moreover, an inner boundary axis 3619 of the intermediate rows of forming pockets 3612B is defined within both the non-welded width 3606 and the slot cavity width 3605. Such an arrangement can significantly deflect the anvil 3600 when clamping tissue and/or as the firing member moves through its staple firing stroke. Such deflections can be a result of the lack of weld penetration depth as well as a relatively large non-welded width 3605 relative to the slot width 3606.

FIG. 79 depicts an anvil 3700 comprising an anvil body portion 3710 and an anvil cap 3720. The anvil body portion 3710 comprises a planar, tissue-facing surface 3711 including a plurality of staple-forming pockets comprising inner staple-forming pockets 3712A, intermediate staple-forming pockets 3712B, and outer staple-forming pockets 3712C. The body portion 3710 further comprises a longitudinal cavity, or slot, 3713 configured to receive a firing member therethrough, anvil-camming ledges 3715 defining radial cam surfaces 3714 configured to be engaged by a firing member as the firing member moves through its staple-firing stroke, and ledges 3716 configured to hold the anvil cap 3730. The slot 3713 comprises a first portion 3713A configured to receive a cutting member of the firing member therethrough and a second portion 3713B configured to receive an upper, camming portion of the firing member therethrough. The first portion 3713A comprises a width that is less than the width of the second portion 3713B.

The anvil cap 3720 comprises a Y-shaped cross section. The anvil cap 3720 comprises a lower portion 3721 configured to be received within the slot 3713 defining a first mating region and an upper portion 3723 configured to be welded to the anvil body 3710. The upper portion 3723 comprises ledges, or shoulders, 3724 comprising horizontal alignment surfaces configured to rest on corresponding horizontal alignment surfaces of the ledges 3716. This interface defines a second mating region which is perpendicular, or at least substantially perpendicular, to the first mating region. The horizontal alignment surfaces are at least substantially parallel to the tissue-facing surface 3711. The upper portion 3723 is flared with respect to the lower portion 3721 and comprises angled weld surfaces 3725 configured to be welded to corresponding angled weld surfaces 3717 of the anvil body 3710 defining a third mating region. The welds comprise weld penetration lengths equal to the length of the angled weld surfaces 3725, 3717.

The anvil 3700 comprises a non-welded width 3706 and a slot width 3705. The non-welded width 3706 is no greater than about 105% of the slot width 3705. A central plane axis “CA” is defined as the geometric center of the anvil 3700. The non-welded width 3706, i.e., the width between the welds, defines an outer boundary axis 3731 which is a first distance 3731D from the central axis CA. The inner staple-forming pockets 3712A define a row axis 3732 which is a second distance 3732D from the central axis CA. The second distance 3732D is less than the first distance 3731D. As a result, all, or at least a portion of, the inner staple-forming pockets 3712A are defined within the non-welded width 3706. In other instances, the inner staple-forming pockets 3712A are positioned entirely outside of the non-welded width 3706. In such instances, the first width 3731D is less than the second width 3732D. In certain instances, the outer boundary axis 3731 does not extend beyond an inner boundary axis of the inner staple forming pockets 3712A. The inner staple-forming pockets 3712A also define an outer boundary axis 3733 which is a third distance 3733D from the central axis CA. The third distance 3733D is greater than the first distance 3731D and the second distance 3732D. In other instances, the inner staple-forming pockets 3712A are entirely positioned within the non-welded width 3706. In such instances, the second distance 3732D and the third distance 3733D are less than the first distance 3731D.

The intermediate staple-forming pockets 3712B define an inner boundary axis 3734 which is a fourth distance 3734D from the central axis. The fourth distance 3734D is greater than the first distance 3731D, the second distance 3732D, and the third distance 3733D. In other words, the non-welded width 3706 does not extend to the intermediate staple-forming pockets 3712B. Minimizing the first distance 3731D, or the distance that the outer boundary axis 3731D extends from the central axis CA, can increase the overall stiffness of the anvil 3700 to reduce the longitudinal and rotational, or torsional, bending, or deflection, of the anvil 3700.

FIG. 80 is a chart 3800 representing four different surgical stapling anvil arrangements subject to two different load scenarios. Model A is a one-piece, or mono-block, anvil. Model B is a two-piece anvil comprising an anvil body and an anvil cap welded to the anvil body. The anvil cap comprises an upper welded portion comprising a non-welded width wider than 105% of the slot width. Like Model B, Model C is a two-piece anvil comprising an anvil body and an anvil cap welded to the anvil body. The anvil cap comprises a non-welded width of about 105% of the slot width. However, the angle of the angular weld surfaces, which are defined between the anvil cap and the anvil body, of Model C prevents a weld depth from being formed that extends the entire length of the angular weld surfaces. In at least one instance, the weld depth is less than 0.03 inches, for example. Model D represents the anvil 3700. The anvil cap comprises a non-welded width of about 105% of the slot width and the angle of the angular weld surfaces of Model D allows a weld depth to be created that fuses the entire length of the angular weld surfaces. In at least one instance, the weld depth is at least 0.03 inches, for example. As a result, the distal tip deflection of the anvil 3700 is less than the distal tip deflection of the anvils of Model A, Model B, and Model C. Also, the overall stress in the ledges of Model B, Model C, and Model D is less than the ledges of Model A.

FIGS. 81-83 depict an anvil 3900 for use with a surgical stapling instrument. The anvil 3900 is configured to deform staples during a surgical stapling procedure. The anvil 3900 comprises an anvil body 3910 and an anvil cap 3920. The anvil body 3910 and the anvil cap 3920 are welded together. The anvil body 3910 comprises a proximal portion 3912 comprising a coupling portion configured to be assembled to an end effector of a surgical stapling instrument to permit rotation of the anvil jaw 3900 relative to a corresponding jaw such as, for example, a staple cartridge jaw. Embodiments are envisioned where the anvil jaw is fixed relative to the staple cartridge jaw and, in such instance, the staple cartridge jaw can rotate relative to the anvil jaw. The anvil body 3910 further comprises a distal tip portion 3914 and a planar, tissue-facing surface 3911. The tissue-facing surface 3911 comprises staple-forming pockets 3912 defined therein which are configured to deform staples during a surgical stapling procedure. The anvil body 3910 comprises a longitudinal slot 3913 configured to receive a firing member of the surgical instrument therethrough. The anvil body 3910 further comprises camming features 3914 including radial camming surfaces 3915 configured to be engaged by anvil-camming portions of the firing member during its staple firing stroke.

Referring to FIG. 81 , the anvil cap 3920 comprises a plurality of shallow-weld zones 3930 each comprising a zone length 3930L, and a plurality of deep-weld zones 3940, each comprising a zone length 3940L. The zone lengths 3930L, 3940L are equal; however, in other instances, the zone lengths 3930L, 3940L are different. Each shallow-weld zone 3930 of the cap 3920 comprises an upper portion 3933 and a lower portion 3931. The upper portions 3933 comprise flared body portions 3934 including welding surfaces 3935. The flared body portions 3934 are configured to rest on alignment ledges 3916 of the anvil body 3910 while the welding surfaces 3935 are configured to engage, or mate, with corresponding angled welding surfaces 3917 of the anvil body 3910 (FIG. 82 ). Each deep-weld zone 3940 comprises an upper portion 3943 and a lower portion 3941. The lower portion 3941 is accessible via a window 3945 extending through the upper portion 3943 of the deep weld zone 3940. The upper portions 3942 comprise alignment ledges 3944, accessible via the weld access region 3945, which are configured to rest on corresponding alignment ledges 3418 of the anvil body 3910. The alignment ledges 3916 are first distance from the tissue-facing surface 3911 and the alignment ledges 3944 are a second distance from the tissue-facing surface 3911. The first distance is greater than the second distance. In other instances, the first distance and the second distance are equal.

The welding surfaces 3935, 3917 discussed above are configured to be welded together to weld the shallow-weld zones 3930 to the anvil body 3910 with a weld 3936 comprising a weld root 3937 (FIG. 83 ). The weld root 3937 is configured to penetrate at least to the horizontal surface of the ledge 3916. The deep-weld zones 3940 are configured to be welded to the anvil body 3910 with a weld 3946 comprising a weld root 3947 (FIG. 83 ). The weld access region 3945 permits a deep weld, welding the lower portion 3941 to the anvil body 3910. During welding, the entire ledge 3946 may be fused with the anvil body 3910. While the weld lengths 3938, 3948 may be similar, if not equal, the effective, or net, weld depth between the anvil cap 3920 and the anvil body 3910 increases by providing both shallow-weld zones 3930 and deep-weld zones 3940. The weld depth can be defined as the distance between an edge 3921 of an upper surface 3901 of the anvil to the weld root of the respective weld. Alternating the shallow-weld zones 3930 and the deep-weld zones 3940 can permit shallow and deep welds on both sides of the anvil 3900 along the longitudinal length of the anvil 3900 and create a robust connection between the anvil cap 3920 and the anvil body 3910.

The shallow-weld zones 3930 and the deep-weld zones 3940 are configured increase the overall weld depth along the length of the anvil 3900. The location, longitudinal length, and quantity of shallow-weld zones 3930 and deep-weld zones 3940 can be varied to change, or tune, the stiffness of the anvil 3900 along its length. For example, the shallow-weld zones 3930 comprise a first stiffness and the deep-weld zones 3940 comprise a second stiffness which is different than the first stiffness. Such an arrangement can also permit the use of a single-depth welder to make the welds 3936, 3946, which can simplify manufacturing. In addition to these welds, a filler weld may be applied to fill the access regions 3945 after the welds 3946 have been made to increase stiffness of the anvil 3900 and reduce the likelihood of rotational deflection within the anvil 3900. Embodiments are envisioned where, instead of having longitudinally alternating zones having deep welds on both sides of the anvil and zones having shallow welds on both sides of the anvil (FIG. 81 ), the anvil comprises a plurality of zones extending a length L where each zone comprises a shallow weld and a deep weld on opposite sides of the anvil. For example, each zone comprises a shallow weld extending along a length L of the zone on one side of the anvil and a deep weld extending along the length L of the zone on the other side of the anvil. Moreover, in addition to having different lengths, the plurality of zones may alternate which side the shallow weld and the deep weld are made. As a result, such an anvil would comprise of both a shallow weld and a deep weld along the entire length of the anvil.

Various surgical stapling anvils disclosed herein can be manufactured using a variety of processes. For example, the anvil body portion and/or the anvil cap portions can be manufactured using a metal injection molding process. The anvil body portion and/or the anvil cap portions can also be manufactured using a machining process. In at least one instance, one of the anvil body portion and the anvil cap is manufactured using a metal injection molding process and the other one of the anvil body portion and the anvil cap is entirely manufactured using a machining process. In certain instances, electrochemical machining processes may be used to form anvil body portion, the anvil cap portion, or both the anvil body portion and the anvil cap portion. Molding processes may permit fillets to be easily incorporated into the geometries of the anvil cap and/or anvil body. Such fillets can reduce stress concentrations at locations where otherwise distinct vertices, or corners, would exist.

A method for manufacturing a surgical stapling anvil such as those disclosed herein may comprise various steps. One step of manufacturing an anvil comprises manufacturing an anvil body portion and an anvil cap member. Another step of manufacturing an anvil comprises polishing anvil-camming surfaces of the anvil body portion. In various instances, any internal surface which may contact any portion of a firing member can be polished. Another step of manufacturing an anvil comprises welding the anvil body portion and the anvil cap member together. The welding step may comprise, for example, a laser welding process. Yet another step of manufacturing an anvil comprises stamping staple-forming, or fastener forming, pockets into a tissue-facing surface of the anvil body portion.

Further to the above, the polishing step can involve polishing various zones of the anvil-camming surfaces, or ledges. The ledges can comprise a first zone and a second zone, wherein the first zone is configured to be contacted by the anvil-camming portions of a firing member and the second zone extends laterally beyond the first zone. Under normal firing circumstances, the firing member would only contact the first ledge zone and not the second ledge zone. Under abnormal firing circumstances, however, a portion of the firing member may contact the second zone. Thus, it can be advantageous to ensure that both the first zone and the second zone of the ledges are polished to reduce the likelihood of galling on the ledges when contacted by the firing member.

FIGS. 84 and 85 depict an anvil 4000 comprising an anvil body 4010 and an anvil cap 4020. The anvil body 4010 comprises a tissue-facing surface 4011 and a plurality of staple forming pockets 4012 defined in the tissue-facing surface 4011. The anvil 4000 comprises a longitudinal cavity 4013 configured to receive a firing member of surgical instrument therethrough. The cavity 4013 comprises anvil-camming surfaces 4015 defined by ledges 4014 of the anvil body 4010. The firing member is configured to cam the ledges 4014 as the firing member is moved through a firing stroke. The anvil cap 4020 is welded to the anvil body 4010. A welder, such as a laser welder, for example, is permitted access to the anvil body 4010 and the anvil cap 4020 via welder access regions 4005. The welder access regions 4005 comprise openings, or beveled edges, to provide space for a welder to access the location to be welded. Larger welder access regions can ensure deeper weld penetration depth.

The anvil 4000 comprises primary welds 4001 and a secondary filler weld 4003. Although only one secondary filler weld 4003 is illustrated, the anvil 4000 may comprise secondary filler weld on top of, or above, all existing primary welds. The filler weld 4003 provides additional stiffness to the anvil 4000 over the longitudinal length of the anvil 4000 and also aids in preventing rotational skew, or torsional bending, or twist, of the anvil sides. Moreover, the filler weld 4003 increases the overall weld penetration depth into the anvil 4000 which increases the stiffness of the anvil 4000. The primary welds 4001 fuse corresponding angular surfaces of the anvil body 4010 and the anvil cap 4020. More specifically, the anvil body 4010 comprises a first angular surface 4019 configured to mate with a first angular surface 4029 of the anvil cap 4020, a first horizontal surface 4018 configured to mate with a first horizontal surface 4028 of the anvil cap 4020, a second angular surface 4017 configured to mate with a second angular surface 4027 of the anvil cap 4020, and a second horizontal surface 4016 configured to mate with a second horizontal surface, or bottom surface, 4026 of the anvil cap 4020. During manufacturing, a welder may be selected and configured to fuse the first angular surfaces 4019, 4029 together.

The additional angular surfaces 4017, 4027 and the horizontal surfaces 4016, 4018, 4026, 4028 are configured to aid the assembly of the anvil body 4010 and the anvil cap 4020 prior to welding during manufacturing. For example, when preparing the anvil body 4010 and the anvil cap 4020 for welding, the additional surfaces may aid in aligning the anvil body 4010 and the anvil 4020 for welding. The second horizontal surface 4016 provides a defined depth for the anvil cap 4020. In other words, the second horizontal surface 4016 defines the lowest, seatable position that the bottom surface 4026 can sit relative to the anvil body 4010.

FIG. 86 depicts an anvil 4100 comprising a first anvil member, or anvil body portion, 4110 and a second anvil member, or anvil cap, 4130. The first anvil member 4110 comprises a tissue-facing surface 4111 comprising a plurality of staple-forming pockets 4112 defined therein. The first anvil member 4110 also comprises a longitudinal cavity 4113 configured to receive a firing member of a surgical instrument therethrough. The first anvil member 4110 further comprises anvil-camming ledges 4114 defining anvil-camming surfaces 4115 configured to be engaged by the firing member as the firing member moves through a firing stroke.

The first anvil member 4110 and the second anvil member 4130 comprise interlocking features configured to increase the overall stiffness of the anvil 4100 and reduce transverse, tissue-induced bending of the anvil 4100 away from an opposing staple cartridge when the anvil 4100 is clamped against the staple cartridge. The first anvil member 4110 comprises horizontally-extending interlocking features 4117 received within corresponding interlocking apertures 4137 of the second anvil member 4130. The first anvil member 4110 also comprises vertically-extending interlocking features 4116 received within corresponding apertures 4136 of the second anvil member 4130. In various instances, the interlocking features 4116, 4117 may require the anvil 4100 to be assembled in only a longitudinal direction prior to being welded together. For example, the second anvil member 4130 may be slid longitudinally relative to the first anvil member in a longitudinal direction to assemble the first anvil member 4110 and the second anvil member 4130.

The first anvil member 4110 and the second anvil member 4130 are welded to each other with exterior welds 4101 and interior welds 4103. Welds 4101, 4103 may comprise laser welds, for example. The exterior welds 4101 are located in the outer, lateral portions 4105 of the anvil 4100. The interior welds 4103 are located in the longitudinal cavity 4113 which is defined by the first anvil member 4110 and the second anvil member 4130. A laser welder, for example, can access the longitudinal cavity 4113 through the opening, or aperture, defined between the camming ledges 4114 to form the interior welds 4103. In various instances, the opening defined by the camming ledges 4114 is sized to permit welder access specifically for the interior welds 4103. Such an arrangement having interior welds, exterior welds, and interlocking features can increase the overall strength of an anvil as well as reduce transverse deflection and/or torsional deflection. The interlocking features can also provide a fixed holding surface so that, while one of the first anvil member and the second anvil member is grounded during the weld preparation process, the other one of the first anvil member and the second anvil member is limited to one plane of motion. Such an arrangement can ensure that the first anvil member and the second anvil member do not move relative to each other prior to, and/or during, the welding process.

Referring now to FIG. 87 , an anvil 4200 comprises an anvil body 4210 and an anvil cap 4220. The anvil body 4210 comprises a planar, tissue-contacting surface 4211 including a plurality of staple-forming pockets 4212 defined therein. The anvil body 4210 also comprises a longitudinal cavity 4213 configured to receive a firing member of a surgical instrument therethrough. The anvil body 4210 further comprises anvil-camming ledges 4214 defining anvil-camming surfaces 4215 configured to be engaged by the firing member as the firing member moves through a firing stroke.

The anvil cap 4220 is positioned within the longitudinal cavity 4213 and is welded to the anvil body 4210 with welds 4201. The welds 4201 may comprise laser welds, for example. The anvil cap 4220 comprises lateral projections, or interlocking features, 4221 configured to be received within apertures 4216 of the anvil body 4210. The welds 4201 comprise a weld depth that does not penetrate into the projections 4221, however, embodiments are envisioned where the welds 4201 extend to the projections 4221 or into the projections 4221.

FIGS. 88-92 depict a surgical stapling assembly 4300 comprising a welded anvil which employs another arrangement to aid in the prevention of, and/or the limiting of, the longitudinal bending of the welded anvil. The surgical stapling assembly 4300 comprises an anvil jaw 4340 comprising an anvil body 4350 and an anvil cap 4360, a cartridge channel jaw 4330 configured to receive a staple cartridge within a cartridge-receiving aperture 4333 thereof, and a closure mechanism 4310 configured to pivot the anvil jaw 4340 relative to the cartridge channel jaw 4330 with a cam mechanism. That said, embodiments are envisioned where the cartridge channel jaw 4330 is pivoted relative to the anvil jaw 4340. The anvil body 4350 comprises a tissue facing surface 4351 comprising a plurality of staple forming pockets defined therein which are configured to deform the staples ejected from a surgical staple cartridge. The stapling assembly 4300 further comprises a firing member 4370 configured to move longitudinally within a slot 4357 of the anvil jaw 4340 and within a slot 4331 of the cartridge channel jaw 4330 to deploy a plurality of staples stored within a staple cartridge and configured to cut tissue captured between the anvil jaw 4340 and the cartridge channel jaw 4330 during a firing stroke.

The surgical stapling assembly 4300 comprises means for improving the overall stiffness and strength of the anvil jaw 4340 by reducing the stiffness of the cartridge channel jaw 4330. The cartridge channel comprises channel walls 4334 comprising proximal wall portions 4335 and distal wall portions 4337. The anvil jaw 4340 is configured to hug, or surround the cartridge channel jaw 4330, specifically the proximal wall portions 4335, when the anvil jaw 4340 is pivoted toward the cartridge channel jaw 4330. The anvil body 4350 comprises proximal surrounding portions 4352 configured to hug, or surround, the proximal wall portions 4335 as the anvil jaw 4340 is pivoted from an open configuration (FIG. 88 ) into a closed configuration (FIG. 89 ) by the closure mechanism 4310. The proximal surrounding portions 4352 further comprise tissue stops 4359 configured to limit the proximal movement of tissue into the surgical stapling assembly 4300.

The proximal surrounding portions 4352 comprise a lower portion 4354, an upper portion 4353, and a ledge 4356 defined therebetween. The lower portions 4354 are configured to overlap the proximal wall portions 4335 when the stapling assembly 4300 is in the closed configuration (FIG. 91 , e.g.). The upper portions 4353 are thicker, or larger, than the lower portions 4354; however, the upper portions 4353 and the lower portions 4354 can have any suitable configuration. Collectively, the thicker upper portions 4353 and the lower portions 4354 are configured to increase the overall stiffness and moment of inertia of the anvil jaw 4340. The ledges 4336 of the channel jaw 4330 face corresponding ledges 4356 of the proximal surrounding portions 4352 when the stapling assembly 4300 is in the closed configuration.

Referring primarily to FIG. 92 , the proximal wall portions 4335 comprise a cutout comprising a wall thickness that is less than that of the distal wall portions 4337. The proximal wall portions 4335 also comprise a smaller height than distal wall portions 4337 (FIG. 91 ). Providing thinner and smaller walls in the proximal portion of the cartridge channel jaw 4330 allows for more space for the proximal surrounding portion 4352 of the anvil jaw 4340 to be thicker and, overall, larger, thus increasing the stiffness of the anvil jaw 4340. In previous designs, the cartridge channel jaw of a stapling assembly comprised a substantially greater stiffness than the anvil of the stapling assembly. The present arrangement sacrifices some of the stiffness of the cartridge channel jaw to stiffen the anvil jaw by removing material from the cartridge channel jaw and adding the material to the anvil jaw all while maintaining a desirable instrument diameter. In various instances, a desired instrument diameter can be 5 mm, 8 mm, or 12 mm, for example. As a result of the above, the proximal surrounding portions 4352 comprise a volume of material configured to occupy a void defined as the space beyond the proximal wall portions 4335 but within the instrument diameter.

Further to the above, the anvil jaw 4340 comprises a first stiffness and the cartridge channel jaw 4330 comprises a second stiffness. The stapling assembly 4300 comprises structural means for reducing the second stiffness to increase the first stiffness. In various instances, the first stiffness and the second stiffness comprise a ratio of between about 1:3 and about 1:1. In some instances, the first stiffness and the second stiffness comprise a ratio of about 1:3. In other instances, the first stiffness and the second stiffness comprise a ratio of about 1:1.

Referring now to FIGS. 93-95 , a cartridge channel jaw 4400 comprises a body portion 4410 and a cap portion 4430. The body portion 4410 comprises a longitudinal cavity 4415 (FIG. 94 ) configured to receive the cap portion 4430. Such an arrangement can permit the polishing of various internal surfaces of the channel jaw 4400 during manufacturing to reduce the force to advance, or fire, a firing member through a surgical instrument. The cartridge channel jaw 4400 comprises a staple cartridge-receiving cavity 4401 defined by channel walls 4411 of the body portion 4410 which is configured to receive a staple cartridge therein, a proximal portion 4405 configured to be coupled to an instrument shaft, and a distal portion 4407. A replaceable staple cartridge is configured to be inserted, or installed, into the cartridge channel jaw 4400. Referring to FIG. 95 , the body portion 4410 further comprises a longitudinal aperture 4413 configured to receive a portion of a firing member of a surgical instrument therethrough as the firing member moves through a staple firing stroke.

The longitudinal cavity 4415 of the body portion 4410 defines ledges 4413 (FIG. 95 ) which are configured to hold the cap portion 4430 in place relative the body portion 4410 for welding. The cap portion 4430 comprises cap walls 4433 and is welded to the body portion 4410 with welds 4409. The welds 4409 may comprise laser welds, for example. The cap portion 4430 and the ledges 4413 of the body portion 4410 define a longitudinal slot 4403 configured to slidingly receive a portion of the firing member. The longitudinal slot 4403 is polished prior to welding the cap portion 4430 to the body portion 4410. In various instances, the entirety of the longitudinal slot 4403 is polished. For example, the internal surfaces of the cap portion 4430 as well as the ledges 4413 are polished. Polishing the ledges 4413 can be advantageous such that, as the firing member moves through its staple firing stroke, the polished ledges 4413 can reduce friction between the cartridge channel jaw 4400 and the firing member and, therefore, galling of the surfaces which would increase the force to fire the surgical instrument. In other instances, only certain surfaces of the cap portion 4430 are polished. In such instances, only the horizontal surface 4435 of the cap portion 4430 and the ledges 4413 may be polished.

FIGS. 96-107 compare two different firing members 4500, 4600 for use with surgical stapling systems 4800, 4700, respectively. The firing member 4500 (FIG. 96 ) comprises a body 4510 comprising a proximal connection portion 4512 and a cutting member 4511 configured to cut tissue during a staple-firing stroke. The firing member 4500 further comprises a channel jaw-coupling member 4520 and a anvil jaw-coupling member 4530 configured to hold an anvil jaw and a channel jaw relative to each other during a staple-firing stroke of the firing member 4500. Similarly, the firing member 4600 (FIG. 97 ) comprises a body 4610 comprising a proximal connection portion 4612, a cutting member 4611 configured to cut tissue during a staple-firing stroke, and a lockout feature 4615. The firing member 4600 further comprises a channel jaw-coupling member 4620 and a anvil jaw-coupling member 4630 configured to hold an anvil jaw and a channel jaw relative to each other during a staple-firing stroke of the firing member 4600.

Referring now to FIGS. 98 and 99 , the anvil jaw-coupling member 4530 of the firing member 4500 comprises lateral projections, or anvil-camming features, 4531 extending from lateral sides of the body 4510. The projections are filleted relative to the body 4510 with fillets 4532. The projections 4531 also comprise outer, rounded corners 4533. The anvil, jaw-coupling member 4530 defines an upper, planar surface 4534. Each projection 4531 comprises a lateral width, or thickness, 4545 and a vertical thickness 4541. The lateral width 4545 is defined as the distance between the body 4510 and an outer edge 4536 of the projection 4531. The lateral projections 4531 define a projection axis 4543 which is angled at about one degree relative to a horizontal surface of firing member 4500 such as, for example, an upper camming surface 4521 of the channel jaw-coupling member 4520. Angling the projections 4531 may reduce galling of the contact surfaces. The lateral projections 4531 further comprise a longitudinal length 4542 (FIG. 102 ) defined as the distance between a leading edge 4535 of the projection 4531 and a trailing edge 4537 of the projection 4531.

The longitudinal length 4542 and the vertical thickness 4541 of the lateral projections 4531 comprise a ratio of between about 2.5:1 and about 20:1, for example. In certain instances, the longitudinal length 4542 and the vertical thickness 4541 comprise a ratio of between about 5:1 and about 10:1. In some instances, the longitudinal length 4542 and the vertical thickness 4541 comprise a ratio of about 5:1. In various instances, the vertical thickness 4541 and the lateral width 4545 comprise a ratio of between about 1:2 and about 1:1, for example. In certain instances, the vertical thickness 4541 and the lateral width 4545 comprise a ratio of about 1:1. These arrangements reduce ledge deflection and, in turn, reduce the deflection of the projections 4531 of the firing member 4500. These arrangements also encourage pure shear as the main source of deflection which increases the ability of the projections to resist deformation. Arrangements where bending of the projections is the main source of deflection may result in a greater likelihood of plastic deformation of the projections.

Referring now to FIGS. 100 and 101 , the anvil jaw-coupling member 4630 comprises lateral projections, or anvil-camming features, 4631 extending from lateral sides of the body 4610. Each projection 4631 comprises a lateral width, or thickness, 4645 and a vertical thickness 4641. The lateral width 4645 is defined as the distance between the body 4610 and an outer edge 4636 of the projection 4631. The lateral projections 4631 further comprise a longitudinal length 4642 (FIG. 103 ) defined as the distance between a leading edge 4635 of the projection 4631 and a trailing edge 4637 of the projection 4631. The longitudinal length 4542 is greater than the longitudinal length 4642.

Turning now to FIG. 104 , a stapling system 4700 comprises an end effector for use with a surgical instrument which includes an anvil jaw 4750, a cartridge channel jaw 4780, and a staple cartridge 4710 installed within the cartridge channel jaw 4780. The stapling system 4700 also comprises the firing member 4600, discussed above. The staple cartridge 4710 comprises a plurality of staples removably stored within staple cavities 4712 of the staple cartridge 4710 configured to be fired by the firing member 4600, a cartridge deck, or tissue-facing surface, 4711, and a longitudinal slot 4713 configured to receive the firing member 4600 therethrough. The anvil jaw 4750 comprises a tissue-facing surface 4751 comprising a plurality of staple-forming pockets 4752 configured to deform the staples, an anvil slot 4753 configured to receive the jaw-coupling member 4630 of the firing member 4600 therethrough, and camming ledges 4755 configured to be engaged by the projections 4631 of the firing member 4600 as the firing member 4600 moves through its staple firing stroke. The channel 4780 comprises channel walls 4781, a longitudinal slot, or cavity, 4785 configured to receive the jaw-coupling member 4620 therethrough, and camming ledges 4783 configured to be engaged by the jaw-coupling member 4620 as the firing member 4600 moves through its staple-firing stroke. In this scenario, the projections 4631 act as cantilever beams resulting in much less force required to bend the projections 4631 than in the system described below.

Turning now to FIG. 105 , a stapling system 4800 comprises an end effector for use with a surgical instrument comprising the anvil jaw 3700, the cartridge channel jaw 4400, and a staple cartridge 4810 installed within the cartridge channel jaw 4400. The system 4800 also comprises the firing member 4500. The staple cartridge 4810 comprises a plurality of staples removably stored within staple cavities 4812 of the staple cartridge 4810 configured to be fired by the firing member 4500, a cartridge deck, or tissue-facing surface, 4811, and a longitudinal slot 4813 configured to receive the firing member 4500 therethrough. The anvil slot 3713 is configured to receive the jaw-coupling member 4530 of the firing member 4500 therethrough and the camming ledges 3715 are configured to be engaged by the projections 4531 as the firing member 4500 moves through its staple firing stroke. In such instances, the rounded edges 4533 of the projections 4531 are configured to engage the radiused portions 3714 of the camming ledges 3715. The longitudinal slot 4403 of channel jaw 4400 is configured to receive the jaw-coupling member 4520 therethrough and the camming ledges 4413 are configured to be engaged by the jaw-coupling member 4520 as the firing member 4500 moves through its staple-firing stroke. In this scenario, the main source of deflection of the projections 4531 is caused by shear stress requiring a much greater force to deform the projections 4531 than the force required to deform the projections 4631 of the system 4700 illustrated in FIG. 104 .

Turning now to FIGS. 106 and 107 , a comparison of the deflection of the ledges of each stapling system 4700, 4800 is illustrated. An identical firing load is applied to the stapling systems 4700, 4800 illustrated in FIGS. 106 and 107 . In FIG. 106 , the system 4800 is illustrated with a deflection 4801. In FIG. 107 , the system 4700 is illustrated with a deflection 4701 which is greater than the deflection 4801. This difference can be due, in part, to the lack of stiffness of the projections 4631, the geometry of the ledges 4755 and their lack of ability to resist bending, the increased stiffness of the projections 4531, and/or the geometry of the ledges 3715 and their ability to resist bending, among other things. For instance, the stapling system 4800 places the projections 4531 and the ledges 3715 primarily in shear increasing their ability to resist deformation. Moreover, rounding the projections and shortening the width of the projections of the firing member increases stiffness of the corresponding jaw-coupling member as well as the anvil due to the fact that more material of the anvil is permitted.

In certain instances, balancing the stiffnesses of the ledge 3715 and the projections 4531 will balance the magnitude of deflection of the ledge 3715 and the magnitude of deflection of the projection 4531 during a firing stroke of the firing member. As a result of such balanced deflections, neither the ledge nor the projection will dominate each other in terms of deflection and, thus, neither the ledge nor the projection will cause the other to plastically deform substantially more than the other and possibly not at all, during the firing stroke. In various instances, the stiffness of the ledge is equal to, substantially equal to, or less than the stiffness of the projection. In certain instances, the height, or vertical thickness, of the ledge is substantially similar to the height, or vertical thickness, of the projection. In addition to, or in lieu of, providing balanced geometries of the ledge and the projection, the materials of the ledge and the projection can be selected based on yield strength and/or hardness values, for example. Having materials with similar yield strengths and/or hardness values of the materials can encourage equal, or balanced, deflection of the ledge and the projection.

FIG. 108 is a stress and strain analysis 4900 of the anvil 3700 comprising a weld 3701 during the advancement of the firing member 4500. As can be seen in FIG. 108 , the combination of the application of a distributed load 4903 by the firing member 4500 to the ledges 3715 and the application of a distributed load 4905 by the tissue and cartridge 4810 to the tissue-facing surface 3711 results in a deflection 4901 and a stress profile as illustrated. The stress analysis shows low stress regions 4907, medium stress regions 4908, and high stress regions 4909. Notably, the stress at and near the weld 3701 is evenly distributed and does not localize, or concentrate, at or near the weld 3701.

In various designs, a T-shaped cutter bit is used to machine the slot in the anvil and/or channel that receives the jaw-coupling members of a firing member. This method of machining can cause bit chatter which can roughen the surface of the slots cut with the T-shaped cutter bit. In two-piece anvil and channel designs, a standard cutter bit can be used eliminating this issue to provide a better surface finish and resulting in a reduced force to fire the firing member.

Another way to reduce the force to fire may include coating at least the polished surfaces of the anvil with a material to reduce the coefficient of friction of those surfaces. Such a coating can comprise Medcoat 2000, for example.

During manufacturing of various welded anvil designs disclosed herein, x-ray techniques may be employed to verify weld depth and/or weld integrity to reduce faulty resultant welds from passing a quality control test lacking an x-ray step. Another quality control step may include a batch destructive test where an anvil is sliced and then analyzed to ensure proper weld depth and/or weld integrity.

Various materials to increase strength and/or provide desirable weld materials may be used in the manufacturing of various two-piece anvil designs disclosed herein. For example, a Tungsten-rhenium alloy may be used for the anvil cap material. In various instances, a W-3, W-5, W-25, or W-26 Tungsten-rhenium alloy may be used for the anvil cap material. In some instances, a silver-nickel clad may be used for the anvil cap and a 416 stainless steel or 17-4 stainless steel may be used for the anvil body, for example.

As discussed above, the anvil body and the anvil cap may comprise different materials. These materials can be selected based on weldability and/or strength, for example. In addition to weldability and strength, another material selection process may factor in hardness. This can be particularly important for the anvil-camming ledges of the anvil body. In some instances, the material selected for the anvil body can comprise of a hardness value which is greater than the hardness value of the anvil cap. The anvil-camming ledges may then be less resistant to galling than if the anvil body and the anvil cap were both manufactured using a softer material.

In certain instances, the rows of forming pockets may be stamped into the tissue-facing surface of the anvil. In such instances, a slit, or notch, may be cut into the tissue-facing surface to provide space for material to move toward, or into, during the stamping process. This may permit all of the forming pocket rows to comprise forming pockets having equal pocket depths where stamping the pockets without the precut slit may make equal pocket depths amongst the rows difficult.

FIGS. 109-114 depict a forming pocket arrangement 10200 that is configured to deform a staple during a surgical stapling procedure. The forming pocket arrangement 10200 and various alternative forming pocket arrangements are further described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,914, entitled METHOD OF DEFORMING STAPLES FROM TWO DIFFERENT TYPES OF STAPLE CARTRIDGES WITH THE SAME SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENT, which was filed Dec. 21, 2016. U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,914 is incorporated by reference herein in its entirety. The forming pocket arrangement 10200 comprises a proximal forming pocket 10210 and a distal forming pocket 10230 defined in a planar, or tissue-engaging, surface 10207 of an anvil 10201. The pockets 10210, 10230 are aligned along a longitudinal pocket axis 10203 of the forming pocket arrangement 10200. A staple is intended to be formed along the pocket axis 10203 by the forming pocket arrangement 10200 when deployed from a staple cartridge. Referring to FIGS. 110 and 111 , the forming pocket arrangement 10200 further comprises a bridge portion 10205 defined between the forming pockets 10210, 10230. In this instance, the bridge portion 10205 is recessed with respect to the planar surface 10207 of the anvil 10201. The bridge portion 10205 comprises a bridge width “W” and a bridge depth “D”. The bridge depth “D” is the distance that the bridge portion 10205 is recessed with respect to the planar surface 10207. The forming pocket arrangement 10200 comprises a center “C” defined within the bridge portion 10205. The forming pocket arrangement 10200 is bilaterally symmetric with respect to the bridge portion 10205, bilaterally symmetric with respect to pocket axis 10203, and rotationally symmetric with respect to the center “C”.

The forming pocket arrangement 10200 further comprises a pair of primary sidewalls 10208 extending from the planar surface 10207 of the anvil 10201 toward the pockets 10210, 10230 and the bridge portion 10205. The primary sidewalls 10208 are angled at angle θ₂ (FIG. 112 ) with respect to the planar surface 10207 of the anvil 10201. The forming pocket arrangement 10200 further comprises edge features 10215, 10235 which provide a transition feature between the outer edges of the pockets 10210, 10230 and the planar surface 10207, between the longitudinal edges of the pockets 10210, 10230 and the primary sidewalls 10208, and between the inner edges of pockets 10210, 10230 and the bridge portion 10205. These edges 10215, 10235 can be rounded, and/or chamfered, for example. The edge features 10215, 10235 may help prevent staple tips from sticking.

The forming pocket 10210 comprises a pair of pocket sidewalls 10213 and the forming pocket 10230 comprises a pair of pocket sidewalls 10233. The pocket sidewalls 10213, 10233 are configured to direct the staple tips and the legs of the staples toward the forming surfaces of the pockets 10210, 10230 in the event that the staple tips and/or the legs of the staples initially strike the sidewalls 10213, 10233 of the pockets 10210, 10230. The sidewalls 10213, 10233 extend from the transition edges 10215, 10235 toward the forming surfaces of each pocket 10210, 10230. The sidewalls 10213, 10233 of the forming pockets 10210, 10230 are angled with respect to the planar surface 10207 of the anvil 10201 at angle θ₁ (FIG. 113 ) in order to direct, or channel, the legs and/or the staple tips of the staples toward the forming surfaces of the pockets 10210, 10230. The sidewalls 10213, 10233 are configured to encourage the staple tips and/or the legs of the staples to form along the pocket axis 10203 as the staples are formed against the forming surfaces of the pockets 10210, 10230. Collectively, the primary sidewalls 10208 and the pocket sidewalls 10213, 10233 can provide a funnel-like configuration for directing staple tips. Referring to FIGS. 112 and 113 , the angle θ₁ is greater than the angle θ₂.

The pockets 10210, 10230 further comprise transition edges 10214, 10234 which provide a transition feature between the pocket sidewalls 10213, 10233 and the forming surfaces, as discussed in greater detail below. In various instances, the transition edges 10214, 10234 can comprise a similar profile as the transition edges 10215, 10235. In other instances, the transition edges 10214, 10234 can comprise a different profile than the transition edges 10215, 10235. That said, the edges 10214, 10234 can be rounded, or chamfered, for example. The edges 10214, 10234 comprise a first end where the edges 10214, 10234 meet the outer ends of the pockets 10210, 10230 and a second end where the edges 10214, 10234 approach the bridge portion 10205, or the inner ends of the pockets 10210, 10230. The edges 10214, 10234 may transition into the transition edges 10215, 10235 near the bridge portion 10205. The edge features 10214, 10234 may also help prevent staple tips from sticking in the pockets 10210, 10230 when forming.

Referring again to FIG. 110 , the forming surfaces of the pockets 10210, 10230 comprise an entry zone forming surface 10211, 10231 and an exit zone forming surface 10212, 10232, respectively. In this instance, the amount of surface area of the forming surfaces that the entry zone forming surfaces 10211, 10231 cover is greater than the amount of surface area of the forming surfaces that the exit zone forming surfaces 10212, 10232 cover. As a result, the entry zone forming surfaces 10211, 10231 do not transition to the exit zone forming surfaces 10212, 10232 in the center of each pocket 10210, 10230. Rather, the transition points where the entry zones 10211, 10231 transition to the exit zones 10212, 10232 are closer to the bridge portion 10205. The transitions between the entry zone forming surfaces 10211, 10231 and the exit zone forming surfaces 10212, 10232 define a valley, or trough of each pocket 10210, 10230. The valleys of the forming pockets 10210, 10230 define a portion, or segment, of the forming surfaces having the greatest vertical distance from the planar surface 10207.

Referring to FIG. 111 , the forming surfaces of each pocket 10210, 10230 comprise more than one radius of curvature. Specifically, the pocket 10210 comprises an entry radius of curvature 10217 corresponding to the entry zone forming surface 10211 and an exit radius of curvature 10218 corresponding to the exit zone forming surface 10212. Similarly, the pocket 10230 comprises an entry radius of curvature 10237 corresponding to the entry zone forming surface 10231 and an exit radius of curvature 10238 corresponding to the exit zone forming surface 10232. In this instance, the entry radii of curvature 10217, 10237 are larger than the exit radii of curvature 10218, 10238, respectively. Specific relationships between the radii of curvature and various pocket features along with some potential advantages and patterns of the specific relationships are further described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,914.

In addition to defining the transition points where the entry zones transition to the exit zones, the valleys of the forming pockets 10210, 10230 also define the narrowest portion of the forming surfaces of each pocket 10210, 10230. The outer edges of each pocket 10210, 10230, also referred to as entry edges because they define the beginning of the entry zone forming surfaces 10211, 10231, comprise an entry width. The inner edges of each pocket 10210, 10230, also referred to as exit edges because they define the end of the exit zone forming surfaces 10212, 10232, comprise an exit width. In this instance, the entry width is greater than the exit width. Also, the exit width is greater than the valley width, or the narrowest portion of the forming surfaces. FIG. 113 is a cross-sectional view of the distal forming pocket 10230 taken along line 113-113 in FIG. 110 . This view illustrates the valley, or trough, of the distal forming pocket 10230. This valley, or trough, is also the transition between the entry zone forming surface 10231 and the exit zone forming surface 10232. FIG. 112 illustrates a cross-sectional view of the distal forming pocket 10230 taken along line 112-112 in FIG. 110 which is located within the exit zone forming surface 10232 of the forming pocket 10230. FIG. 114 is a cross-sectional view of the distal forming pocket 10230 taken along line 114-114 in FIG. 110 which is within the entry zone forming surface 10232 of the distal forming pocket 10230.

The forming pocket arrangement 10200, and various other forming pocket arrangements disclosed herein, are configured to be used with staples with various diameters. The diameters of staples to be used with the forming pocket arrangement 10200 can vary between about 0.0079 inches and about 0.0094 inches, for example. Additionally, the entry radius of curvature and the exit radius of curvature of each forming surface comprise a ratio of about 1.5:1 to about 3:1 when the entry radius is between about 8× the staple diameter and 10× the staple diameter, for example. In at least one instance, the entry radius of curvature and the exit radius of curvature of each forming surface comprise a ratio of about 2:1 when the entry radius is 9× the staple diameter, for example. In other instances, the entry radius of curvature and the exit radius of curvature of each forming surface comprise a ratio of about 1.5:1 to about 3:1 when the entry radius is above about 0.6× the staple crown length and the ridge, or bridge, width is less than 1× the staple diameter, for example. In at least one instance, the entry radius of curvature and the exit radius of curvature of each forming surface comprise a ratio of about 2:1 when the entry radius is above about 0.6× the staple crown length and the ridge, or bridge, width is less than 1× the staple diameter. The exit radius of curvature is between about 4× the staple diameter and about 6× diameter, for example. In at least one instance, the exit radius of curvature is about 4.5× the staple diameter.

FIGS. 115-120 depict a forming pocket arrangement 10500 that is configured to deform a staple during a surgical stapling procedure. The forming pocket arrangement 10500 and various alternative forming pocket arrangements are further described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,914, entitled METHOD OF DEFORMING STAPLES FROM TWO DIFFERENT TYPES OF STAPLE CARTRIDGES WITH THE SAME SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENT, which was filed Dec. 21, 2016. U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,914 is incorporated by reference herein in its entirety. The forming pocket arrangement 10500 comprises a proximal forming pocket 10510 and a distal forming pocket 10530 defined in a planar, or tissue-contacting, surface 10507 of an anvil 10501. The pockets 10510, 10530 are aligned along a longitudinal pocket axis 10503 of the forming pocket arrangement 10500. A staple is intended to be formed along the pocket axis 10503 by the forming pocket arrangement 10500 when deployed from a staple cartridge. Referring to FIGS. 116 and 117 , the forming pocket arrangement 10500 further comprises a bridge portion 10505 defined between the forming pockets 10510, 10530. In this instance, the bridge portion 10505 is recessed with respect to the planar surface 10507 of the anvil 10501. The bridge portion 10505 comprises a bridge width “W” and a bridge depth “D”. The bridge portion 10505 is substantially V-shaped with a rounded bottom portion. The bridge depth “D” is the distance that the bottom portion of the bridge portion 10505 is recessed with respect to the planar surface 10507. The forming pocket arrangement 10500 comprises a center “C” defined within the bridge portion 10505. The forming pocket arrangement 10500 is bilaterally symmetric with respect to the bridge portion 10505, bilaterally symmetric with respect to pocket axis 10503, and rotationally symmetric with respect to the center “C”.

The forming pocket arrangement 10500 further comprises a pair of primary sidewalls 10508 extending from the planar surface 10507 of the anvil 10501 toward the pockets 10510, 10530 and the bridge portion 10505. The primary sidewalls 10508 are angled at angle θ₁ (FIG. 118 ) with respect to the planar surface 10507 of the anvil 10501. The primary sidewalls 10508 comprise inner edges that are curved, or contoured, with respect to the pockets 10510, 10530.

The forming pocket 10510 comprises a pair of pocket sidewalls 10513 and the forming pocket 10530 comprises a pair of pocket sidewalls 10533. The pocket sidewalls 10513, 10533 comprise curved, or contoured, profiles and are configured to direct the staple tips and the legs of the staples toward the forming surfaces of the pockets 10510, 10530 as well as help control the forming process of the staples. The sidewalls 10513, 10533 extend from the primary sidewalls 10508 and the planar surface 10507 toward the forming surfaces of each pocket 10510, 10530. The sidewalls 10513, 10533 are configured to encourage the staple tips and/or the legs of the staples to form along the pocket axis 10503 as the staples are formed against the forming surfaces of the pockets 10510, 10530. Collectively, the primary sidewalls 10508 and the pocket sidewalls 10513, 10533 cooperate to funnel corresponding staple tips toward the lateral center of each pocket 10510, 10530. Discussed in greater detail below, the sidewalls 10513, 10533 comprise entry portions and exit portions where the entry portions comprise a less aggressive channeling configuration than the exit portions.

Referring again to FIG. 116 , the forming surfaces of the pockets 10510, 10530 comprise an entry zone forming surface 10511, 10531 and an exit zone forming surface 10512, 10532, respectively. The entry zone forming surfaces 10511, 10531 coincide with the less aggressive channeling portions of the sidewalls 10513, 10533. Similarly, the exit zone forming surfaces 10512, 10532 coincide with the more aggressive channeling portions of the sidewalls 10513, 10533. The pockets 10510, 10530 further comprise a forming, or guiding, groove 10515, 10535, also referred to as a tip control channel, extending the entire longitudinal length of each pocket 10510, 10530 and positioned centrally with respect to the outer lateral edges of the pockets 10510, 10530. The grooves 10515, 10535 are narrower at the outer longitudinal edges of the pockets 10510, 10530 than the inner longitudinal edges of the pockets 10510, 10530. The grooves 10515, 10535 meet at the bridge portion 10505 to encourage the staple tips, and staple legs, to contact each other during the forming process, as further discussed in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,914. In some instances, grooves defined in the forming surfaces of forming pockets can have a similar effect in staple forming as more aggressively-angled exit walls and/or narrowly-configured exit walls.

Referring to FIG. 117 , the forming surfaces of each pocket 10510, 10530 comprise more than one radius of curvature. Specifically, the pocket 10510 comprises an entry radius of curvature 10517 corresponding to the entry zone forming surface 10511 and an exit radius of curvature 10518 corresponding to the exit zone forming surface 10512. Similarly, the pocket 10530 comprises an entry radius of curvature 10537 corresponding to the entry zone forming surface 10531 and an exit radius of curvature 10538 corresponding to the exit zone forming surface 10532. In this instance, the entry radii of curvature 10517, 10537 are larger than the exit radii of curvature 10518, 10538. Specific relationships between the radii of curvature and various pocket features along with some potential advantages and patterns of the specific relationships are further described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,914.

Referring now to FIGS. 118-120 , the outer longitudinal edges of each pocket 10510, 10530 are referred to as entry edges because they define the beginning of the entry zone forming surfaces 10511, 10531. The entry edges comprise an entry width which is the largest width of the forming surfaces of each pocket 10510, 10530. The inner edges of each pocket 10510, 10530 are referred to as exit edges because they define the end of the exit zone forming surfaces 10512, 10532. The exit edges comprise an exit width, also referred to as the bridge width “W”, which is the narrowest section of the forming surfaces of each pocket 10510, 10530. The transitions between entry and exit zones comprise a transition width which is less than the entry width but greater than the exit width. FIG. 119 is a cross-sectional view of the distal forming pocket 10530 taken along line 119-119 in FIG. 116 . This view is taken near the valley, or trough, of the distal forming pocket 10530. This valley, or trough, is also the transition between the entry zone forming surface 10531 and the exit zone forming surface 10532. In various instances, the transition between entry and exit zones does not occur at the valley, or trough, of the pocket. FIG. 118 illustrates a cross-sectional view of the distal forming pocket 10530 taken along line 118-118 in FIG. 116 which is located within the exit zone forming surface 10532 of the forming pocket 10530. FIG. 120 is a cross-sectional view of the distal forming pocket 10530 taken along line 120-120 in FIG. 116 which is within the entry zone forming surface 10532 of the distal forming pocket 10530. The sidewalls 10533 are illustrated in this figure as linear, or at least substantially linear, and are angled at angle θ₂ (FIG. 120 ) with respect to the planar surface 10507. Angle θ₂ is greater than angle θ₁ (FIG. 118 ).

FIGS. 121 and 122 depict staples formed with the forming pocket arrangement 10500 where one staple was aligned with the pocket axis 10503 of the forming pocket arrangement 10500 and the other staple was misaligned with the pocket axis 10503 of the forming pocket arrangement 10500. FIG. 121 depicts a side view 13100 and a bottom view 13100′ of a staple 13101 in a fully-formed configuration formed with the forming pocket arrangement 10500. This staple 13101 was aligned with the pocket axis 10503 of the forming pocket arrangement 10500 during the forming process. The tips 13104 of the staple legs 13103 struck the forming pocket arrangement 10500 along the pocket axis 10503.

The staple 13101 comprises a first tip alignment axis TA1, a second tip alignment axis TA2, and a crown alignment axis CA. When aligned with the pocket axis 10503, the staple 13101 forms such that the second tip alignment axis TA2 and the crown alignment axis CA are substantially aligned or, in other words, the staple 13101 assumes a substantially planar configuration. The force to fire the staple 13101 is illustrated in the graph 13110.

FIG. 122 depicts a side view 13120 and a bottom view 13120′ of a staple 13121 in a fully formed configuration formed with the forming pocket arrangement 10500. This staple 13121 was misaligned with the pocket axis 10503 of the forming pocket arrangement 10500 during the forming process. The staple 13121 was driven off plane with respect to the pocket axis 10503. The tips 13124 of the staple legs 13123 did not strike the forming pocket arrangement 10500 along the pocket axis 10503 nor was the crown, or base, 13122 of the staple 13121 aligned with the pocket axis 10503 during forming.

The staple 13121 comprises a first tip alignment axis TA1, a second tip alignment axis TA2, and a crown alignment axis CA. When misaligned with the pocket axis 10503, the staple 13121 forms such that the second tip alignment axis TA2 and the crown alignment axis CA are substantially aligned with each other or, in other words, the staple 13121 assumes a substantially planar configuration. Compared to FIG. 121 where the staple 13101 was aligned with the pocket axis 10503, the staple 13121 forms into a fully-formed configuration that may be more acceptable to a surgeon to more adequately seal tissue than staples formed with other forming pocket arrangements which form in a misaligned state.

FIGS. 123-129 depict a forming pocket arrangement 6500 that is configured to deform a staple during a surgical stapling procedure. The forming pocket arrangement 6500 comprises a proximal forming cup, or pocket, 6510 and a distal forming cup, or pocket, 6530 defined in a planar, or tissue-contacting, surface 6507 of an anvil 6501. The tissue-contacting surface 6507 of the anvil 6501 can be configured to compress tissue against a staple cartridge when the anvil 6501 is clamped or closed relative to the staple cartridge. Each cup 6510, 6530 is defined by a boundary surface as further described herein. The cups 6510, 6530 are aligned along a pocket axis 6503 of the forming pocket arrangement 6500. A staple is intended to be formed along the pocket axis 6503 by the forming pocket arrangement 6500 when deployed from a staple cartridge. For example, a first leg of the staple is formed by the proximal forming cup 6510 and a second leg of the staple is formed by the distal forming cup 6530. In such instances, the first leg of the staple is aligned with a portion of the proximal forming cup 6510 and the second leg of the staple is aligned with a portion of the distal forming cup 6530 when the anvil 6501 is clamped relative to the staple cartridge.

Referring to FIGS. 125 and 126 , the forming pocket arrangement 6500 further comprises a bridge portion 6505 defined between the forming cups 6510, 6530. In this instance, the bridge portion 6505 is recessed with respect to the planar surface 6507 of the anvil 6501. The bridge portion 6505 comprises a bridge width BW and a bridge depth BD (FIG. 129 ). The bridge depth BD is the distance that the bottom portion of the bridge portion 6505 is recessed with respect to the planar surface 6507. The bridge width BW is the width of the pocket arrangement 6500 between the cups 6510, 6530. In this instance, the bridge width BW is the narrowest section of the forming surfaces of each cup 6510, 6530. The forming pocket arrangement 6500 comprises a center C (FIGS. 123-125 ) defined within the bridge portion 6505. The forming pocket arrangement 6500 is bilaterally symmetric with respect to the bridge portion 6505, bilaterally symmetric with respect to pocket axis 6503, and rotationally symmetric with respect to the center C.

The forming pocket arrangement 6500 further comprises a pair of primary sidewalls 6508 extending from the planar surface 6507 of the anvil 6501 toward the cups 6510, 6530 and the bridge portion 6505. The primary sidewalls 6508 are angled at an angle θ₁ (FIGS. 127-129 ) with respect to the planar surface 6507 of the anvil 6501. The cups 6510, 6530 define a perimeter 6520 and the inner edges of the primary sidewalls 6508 extend between the planar surface 6507 and the perimeter 6520 of the cups 6510, 6530. Referring primarily to FIG. 125 , the inner edges of the primary sidewalls 6508 are curved, or contoured, with respect to the cups 6510, 6530.

In certain instances, the forming pocket arrangement 6500 may not include the primary sidewalls 6508. In such instances, the cups 6510, 6530 can extend directly to the planar surface 6507 and the perimeter 6520 of the cups 6510, 6530 can be defined in the planar surface 6507.

Referring again to FIGS. 125 and 126 , the proximal forming cup 6510 comprises a pair of cup sidewalls 6513 and the distal forming cup 6530 comprises a pair of cup sidewalls 6533. The cup sidewalls 6513, 6533 comprise curved, or contoured, profiles and are configured to direct the staple tips and the legs of the staples toward the forming surfaces of the cups 6510, 6530 as well as help control the forming process of the staples. The sidewalls 6513, 6533 extend from the primary sidewalls 6508 and the planar surface 6507 toward the forming surfaces of each cup 6510, 6530. The sidewalls 6513, 6533 are configured to encourage the staple tips and/or the legs of the staples to form along the pocket axis 6503 as the staples are formed against the forming surfaces of the cups 6510, 6530. Collectively, the primary sidewalls 6508 and the cup sidewalls 6513, 6533 cooperate to funnel corresponding staple tips toward the lateral center of each cup 6510, 6530. An inflection surface, or bottom surface, 6514, 6534 extends along the lateral center of each respective cup 6510, 6530 intermediate the respective sidewalls 6513, 6533.

Referring still to FIG. 125 , the forming surfaces of the cups 6510, 6530 comprise an entry zone forming surface 6511, 6531, respectively, and an exit zone forming surface 6512, 6532, respectively. The entry zone forming surfaces 6511, 6531 can coincide with less aggressive channeling portions of the sidewalls 6513, 6533. Similarly, the exit zone forming surfaces 6512, 6532 can coincide with more aggressive channeling portions of the sidewalls 6513, 6533.

Referring primarily now to FIG. 126 , the forming surfaces of each cup 6510, 6530 are defined by a depth profile or contour. The proximal forming cup 6510 includes the depth profile 6522, and the distal forming cup 6530 includes the depth profile 6542. The depth profiles 6522, 6542 define the depth of the cups 6510, 6530, respectively, along the length thereof. The cups 6510, 6530 reach a maximum cup depth CD within their respective transition zones 6509, 6529, which are further described below. The cup depth CD of the pockets 6510, 6530 can be between 0.3 and 0.5 millimeters, for example. For example, the cup depth CD can be 0.4 millimeters. In other instances, the cup depth CD can be less than 0.3 millimeters or more than 0.5 millimeters, for example.

The depth profiles 6522, 6542 are curved profiles, which are devoid of linear portions. Moreover, the depth profiles 6522, 6542 can comprise one or more radii of curvature. Specifically, the depth profile 6522 of the proximal forming cup 6510 comprises an entry radius of curvature 6517 corresponding to the entry zone forming surface 6511 and an exit radius of curvature 6518 corresponding to the exit zone forming surface 6512. Similarly, the depth profile 6542 of the distal forming cup 6530 comprises an entry radius of curvature 6537 corresponding to the entry zone forming surface 6531 and an exit radius of curvature 6538 corresponding to the exit zone forming surface 6532. In this instance, the entry radii of curvature 6517, 6537 are larger than the exit radii of curvature 6518, 6538. Specific relationships between the entry zone and exit zone radii of curvature and various pocket features along with some potential advantages and patterns of the specific relationships are further described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,914.

The outer longitudinal edges of each cup 6510, 6530 are referred to as entry edges because they define the beginning of the entry zone forming surfaces 6511, 6531. The entry edges comprise an entry width which is the largest width of the forming surfaces of each cup 6510, 6530. The inner edges of each cup 6510, 6530 are referred to as exit edges because they define the end of the exit zone forming surfaces 6512, 6532. The exit edges comprise an exit width, also referred to as the bridge width BW (FIG. 129 ) which is the narrowest section of the forming surfaces of each cup 6510, 6530. A transition zone 6509, 6529 is positioned intermediate the entry zone and exit zone of each cup. The transition zones 6509, 6529 have a transition width which is less than the entry width but greater than the exit width. The transition zones 6509, 6529 include an inflection portion of the respective depth profiles 6522, 6542 and, thus, include the deepest portion of each cup 6510, 6530. In various instances, the transition zones 6509, 6529 comprise the majority of the length of each cup 6510, 6530. More specifically, the length of the transition zone 6509, 6529 can be greater than the combined length of the respective entry zone and exit zone of each cup 6510, 6530. The transition zones 6509, 6529 can extend along the tapered or narrowing section of each cup 6510, 6530. For example, each transition zone 6509, 6529 can extend inward from the widest section of the respective cup 6510, 6530 toward the bridge 6505.

FIG. 128 is a cross-sectional view of the distal forming cup 6530 taken along line 128-128 in FIG. 125 . This view is taken near the valley, or trough, of the distal forming cup 6530. This valley, or trough, is also the transition between the entry zone forming surface 6531 and the exit zone forming surface 6532. In various instances, the transition between entry and exit zones does not occur at the valley, or trough, of the cup. FIG. 129 illustrates a cross-sectional view of the distal forming cup 6530 taken along line 129-129 in FIG. 125 which is located within the exit zone forming surface 6532 of the distal forming cup 6530. FIG. 127 is a cross-sectional view of the distal forming cup 6530 taken along line 127-127 in FIG. 125 which is within the entry zone forming surface 6532 of the distal forming cup 6530.

Referring primarily to FIGS. 127-129 , the pair of cup sidewalls 6533 of the distal forming cup 6530 includes a first sidewall 6533 a and a second sidewall 6533 b. The first and second sidewalls 6533 a, 6533 b are opposing sidewalls which extend toward each other from laterally-opposed sides of the distal forming cup 6530. The inflection surface, or bottom surface, 6534 of the distal forming cup 6530 is positioned between the first and second sidewalls 6533 a, 6533 b. The bottom surface 6534 of the distal forming cup 6530 is an entirely-curved, non-flat surface. In other words, the bottom surface 6534 is devoid of flat, planar surfaces. The bottom surface 6534 can define one or more radii of curvature. For example, at various longitudinal positions along the pocket axis 6503, the bottom surface 6534 defines different radii of curvature. A tangent to the bottom surface 6534 at the lateral center of the cup 6530 is parallel to the planar surface 6507 along the length thereof.

In various instances, the curvature of the bottom surface 6534 can be dimensioned such that the staple leg does not travel along a flat surface during the staple forming process. In such instances, the bottom surface 6543 can encourage the staple to form into a more planar formed configuration than staples formed along flat bottom surfaces, especially when the staples are misaligned with the pocket axis 6503 during formation. The curvature of the bottom surface 6543 can be dimensioned such that the bottom surface 6543 provides a plurality of contact surfaces for the staple leg. For example, the radius of curvature of the bottom surface 6534 can be less than the radius of curvature of the staple leg.

The cup sidewalls 6513, 6533 are entirely-curved, non-flat surfaces. In other words, the cup sidewalls 6513, 6533 are devoid of flat, planar surfaces. Referring again to FIGS. 127-129 , the sidewalls 6533 a, 6533 b define one or more radii of curvature. For example, at various longitudinal positions along the pocket axis 6503, the sidewalls 6533 a, 6533 b define different radii of curvature. The entirely-curved contours of the cup sidewalls 6513, 6533 and the bottom surface 6534 can define curvilinear boundary surfaces of the cups 6510, 6530. The cups 6513, 6533 can be entirely-curved and devoid of flat, planar surfaces.

The sidewalls 6533 a, 6533 b are oriented at an entry angle θ₂ relative to the tissue-contacting surface 6507 at various transverse cross-sections of the distal forming cup 6530. More specifically, a tangent T to each sidewall 6533 a, 6533 b at the perimeter 6520 of the distal forming cup 6530 is oriented at the angle θ₂ relative to the tissue-contacting surface 6507 in FIGS. 127-129 . The entry angle θ₂ is constant within the transition forming zone 6529 (FIGS. 125 and 126 ) and along the majority of the length of the distal forming cup 6530. Though the tangent to such sidewalls is oriented at a constant angle along the length, or substantial length, of the cups 6510, 6530, the radius of curvature and the length of the arcs defining the sidewalls can vary as the depth and width of the cups varies along the length thereof. In various instances, the angle θ₂ can be between 55 degrees and 80 degrees, for example. For example, in FIGS. 127-129 , the angle θ₂ is 80 degrees. In other instances, the angle θ₂ can be less than 55 degrees or more than 80 degrees. The sidewalls 6533 a, 6533 b are non-vertical sidewalls and, thus, the angle θ₂ of the tangent T along the perimeter 6520 can be less than 90 degrees, for example.

A datum point at the transition between the sidewalls 6533 a, 6533 b and the bottom surface 6534 is indicated for illustrative purposes in FIGS. 127-129 . For example, the curved boundary surface of the distal forming cup 6530 includes a datum point A at the transition between the sidewall 6533 a and the bottom surface 6534. At each longitudinal position along the cup 6530, the first sidewall 6533 a and the second sidewall 6533 b define a sidewall radius of curvature 6543 and the bottom surface 6534 defines a bottom radius of curvature 6544. The bottom radius of curvature 6544 can be different than the sidewall radius of curvature 6543. The transition between radii of curvature at the datum point A comprises a smooth, non-abrupt transition.

A datum line B is also depicted in FIGS. 127-129 for illustrative purposes. The datum line B extends between the first datum point A and the perimeter 6520 of the distal forming cup 6530. The datum line B is oriented at an angle θ₃ in FIGS. 127-129 . The angle θ₃ can determine where the curved sidewall 6533 a meets the curved bottom surface 6534. Moreover, the steepness of the sidewall 6533 a can be impacted by the angle θ₃. For example, for a constant angle θ₂, an increase in the angle θ₃ can result in a deeper and narrower cup. In certain instances, the angle θ₃ can be limited by a desirable minimum pocket width in the deepest portion of the cup. For example, the desirable minimum pocket width can be a requirement of the tooling process for the anvil 6501 and/or necessitated by the width of the staple wire.

The angle θ₃ is constant within the transition forming surface zone 6529 (FIG. 126 ) and along the majority of the length of the distal forming cup 6530. In various instances, the angle θ₃ can be less than the angle θ₂. The angle θ₃ in FIGS. 127-129 is approximately 55 degrees, for example. In other instances, the angle θ₃ can be less than 55 degrees or more than 80 degrees, for example. Though the angles θ₂ and θ₃ are constant along the length of the distal forming cup 6530, or at least along the substantial length of the distal forming cup 6530, the radius of curvature and the length of the arcs defining the sidewalls 6533 a, 6533 b varies as the depth and width of the distal forming cup 6530 varies along the length thereof.

The angle θ₂ relative to a tissue-contacting surface can comprise a relatively steep angle. For example, the angle θ₂ can be greater than the angles θ₁ and θ₃. The steepness of the angle θ₂ can encourage the staple to form along the pocket axis. Moreover, a constant angle θ₂ along the length of the distal forming cup 6530 can encourage a misaligned staple leg to move from the perimeter toward the lateral center or axis 6503 of the cup 6530. As described herein, the depth of the pocket can vary along the length thereof. However, maintaining a constant angle θ₂ can encourage a misaligned staple leg to move from the perimeter toward the lateral center of the distal forming cup 6530 even in shallower regions of the cup 6530.

In certain instances, the maximum cup depth CD can vary between staple-forming pockets and/or arrangements in an anvil. For example, different depths can be utilized to form staples to different heights and/or to form staples driven by drivers having different heights, as further described herein. The depth of the pockets can vary across the rows of pockets and/or within one or more rows of pockets, for example. Deeper pockets can provide increased control over staple formation; however, the depth of the pockets can be limited by anvil tooling constraints and the geometry of the staples. In instances in which certain pockets are shallower than other pockets, the sidewalls of the shallower pockets can be oriented at the same entry angle θ₂ as the deeper pockets to encourage the staples formed by the shallower pockets to form along the pocket axis.

FIG. 129A is a partial negative view of various slices of a forming pocket of the forming pocket arrangement 6500. The dimensions of the various slices are labeled thereon. The slices are of only a single sidewall of the forming pocket and are taken in planes along the forming pocket which are perpendicular to the tissue-contacting surface 6507 and the pocket axis 6503. Each slice comprises a width “x”, a height “y”, an upper radius of curvature “ra”, and a lower radius of curvature “rb”. The width “x” is defined as the x-component of the distance between the perimeter 6520 of the forming pocket and the bottom radius of curvature 6544 of the forming pocket. The height “y” is defined as the y-component of the distance between the perimeter 6520 of the forming pocket and the bottom radius of curvature 6544 of the forming pocket. The upper radius of curvature “ra” is defined as the radius of curvature of an upper portion of the sidewall. The lower radius of curvature “rb” is defined as the radius of curvature of an lower portion of the sidewall. Each dimension includes a number indicating which slice the dimension corresponds to. For example, Slice 1 includes a width “x₁”, a height “y₁”, an upper radius of curvature “ra₁”, and a lower radius of curvature “rb₁”. FIG. 129B is a table 6550 comprising the dimensions of the Slices 1-12 of FIG. 129A, in at least one embodiment.

FIG. 129C is a cross-sectional view of the forming pocket arrangement 6500 taken along the pocket axis 6503. FIG. 129C includes various dimensions of the distal forming pocket 6530 of forming pocket arrangement 6500. The length of the forming pocket 6530 is 1.90 mm, for example. The depth of the forming pocket 6530 is 0.40 mm, for example. In certain instances, the distal forming pocket 6530 comprises three radii of curvature: an entry radius of curvature which is 1.90 mm, a first exit radius of curvature which is 1.00 mm, and a second exit radius of curvature which is 0.10 mm, for example. The width of the bridge portion of the distal forming pocket 6530 is defined, in this instance, as the distance between the center of the forming pocket arrangement 6500 and the inner-most edge of the first exit radius of curvature (the edge of the first exit radius of curvature closest to the center of the forming pocket arrangement 6500) is 0.10 mm, for example. The bridge depth is 0.05 mm, for example.

FIGS. 130-135 depict another forming pocket arrangement 6600 in the anvil 6501. The forming pocket arrangement 6600 is configured to deform a staple during a surgical stapling procedure, and comprises a proximal forming cup, or pocket, 6610 and a distal forming cup, or pocket, 6630 defined in the planar, or tissue-contacting, surface 6507 of the anvil 6501. The forming pocket arrangement 6600 can be similar in many respects to the forming pocket arrangement 6500. For example, sidewalls of the staple-forming cups 6610, 6630 can intersect the planar surface 6507 at the same constant entry angle θ₂ along the length thereof. Though the sidewall entry angles θ₂ can be the same for cups 6610 and 6630 as for cups 6510 and 6530 (FIGS. 123-129 ), the maximum cup depth CD can be different, as further described herein. In such instances, the sidewalls of the shallower pockets can define the same entry angle θ₂ as the sidewalls of the deeper pockets, which can encourage proper, planar formation of the staples formed by the different depth pockets.

In other instances, the forming pocket arrangement 6600 can be defined in a different anvil. For example, the anvil 6501 may not include different forming pocket arrangements. Rather, an anvil, such as the anvil 6501, can consist of uniform or identical forming pocket arrangements, for example. In certain instances, the forming pocket arrangement 6600 can be the only forming pocket arrangement in a particular anvil.

Each cup 6610, 6630 is defined by a boundary surface as further described herein. The cups 6610, 6630 are aligned along a pocket axis 6603 of the forming pocket arrangement 6600. A staple is intended to be formed along the pocket axis 6603 by the forming pocket arrangement 6600 when deployed from a staple cartridge. For example, a first leg of the staple can be formed by the proximal forming cup 6610 and a second leg of the staple can be formed by the distal forming cup 6630. In such instances, the first leg of the staple is aligned with a portion of the proximal forming cup 6610 and the second leg of the staple is aligned with a portion of the distal forming cup 6630 when the anvil 6501 is clamped relative to the staple cartridge.

Referring to FIGS. 131 and 132 , the forming pocket arrangement 6600 further comprises a bridge portion 6605 defined between the forming cups 6610, 6630. The bridge portion 6605 is recessed with respect to the planar surface 6507 of the anvil 6501, however, the bridge portion 6605 can be flush with the planar surface 6507. The bridge portion 6605 comprises a bridge width BW and a bridge depth BD (FIG. 135 ). The bridge depth BD is the distance that the bottom portion of the bridge portion 6605 is recessed with respect to the planar surface 6507. The bridge width BW is the width of the pocket arrangement 6600 between the cups 6610, 6630. In this instance, the bridge width BW is the narrowest section of the forming surfaces of each cup 6610, 6630. The forming pocket arrangement 6600 comprises a center C (FIGS. 130 and 131 ) defined within the bridge portion 6605. The forming pocket arrangement 6600 is bilaterally symmetric with respect to the bridge portion 6605, bilaterally symmetric with respect to pocket axis 6603, and rotationally symmetric with respect to the center C.

The forming pocket arrangement 6605 further comprises a pair of primary sidewalls 6608 extending from the planar surface 6507 of the anvil 6501 toward the cups 6610, 6630 and the bridge portion 6605. The primary sidewalls 6608 are angled at an angle θ₁ (FIGS. 133-135 ) with respect to the planar surface 6507 of the anvil 6501. The cups 6610, 6630 define a perimeter 6620 and the inner edges of the primary sidewalls 6608 extend between the planar surface 6507 and the perimeter 6620 of the cups 6610, 6630. Referring primarily to FIG. 131 , the inner edges of the primary sidewalls 6608 are curved, or contoured, with respect to the cups 6610, 6630.

In certain instances, the forming pocket arrangement 6600 may not include the primary sidewalls 6608. In such instances, the cups 6610, 6630 can extend directly to the planar surface 6507 and the perimeter 6620 of the cups 6610, 6630 can be defined in the planar surface 6507.

Referring again to FIGS. 131 and 132 , the proximal forming cup 6610 comprises a pair of cup sidewalls 6613 and the distal forming cup 6630 comprises a pair of cup sidewalls 6633. The cup sidewalls 6613, 6633 comprise curved, or contoured, profiles and are configured to direct the staple tips and the legs of the staples toward the forming surfaces of the cups 6610, 6630 as well as help control the forming process of the staples. The sidewalls 6613, 6633 extend from the primary sidewalls 6608 and the planar surface 6507 toward the forming surfaces of each cup 6610, 6630. The sidewalls 6613, 6633 are configured to encourage the staple tips and/or the legs of the staples to form along the pocket axis 6603 as the staples are formed against the forming surfaces of the cups 6610, 6630. Collectively, the primary sidewalls 6608 and the cup sidewalls 6613, 6633 cooperate to funnel corresponding staple tips toward the lateral center of each cup 6610, 6630. An inflection surface, or bottom surface, 6614, 6634 extends along the lateral center of each respective cup 6610, 6630 intermediate the respective sidewalls 6613, 6633.

Referring still to FIG. 131 , the forming surfaces of the cups 6610, 6630 comprise an entry zone forming surface 6611, 6631, respectively, and an exit zone forming surface 6612, 6632, respectively. The entry zone forming surfaces 6611, 6631 can coincide with less aggressive channeling portions of the sidewalls 6613, 6633. Similarly, the exit zone forming surfaces 6612, 6632 can coincide with more aggressive channeling portions of the sidewalls 6613, 6633.

Referring primarily now to FIG. 132 , the forming surfaces of each cup 6610, 6630 are defined by a depth profile or contour. The proximal forming cup 6610 includes the depth profile 6622, and the distal forming cup 6630 includes the depth profile 6642. The depth profiles 6622, 6642 define the depth of the cups 6610, 6630, respectively, along the length thereof. The cups 6610, 6630 reach a maximum cup depth CD within their respective transition zone 6609, 6629, which are further described below. The cup depth CD of the pockets 6610, 6630 can be between 0.2 and 0.4 millimeters, for example. For instance, the cup depth CD can be 0.3 millimeters. In other instances, the cup depth CD can be less than 0.2 millimeters or more than 0.4 millimeters.

The cup depth CD of the cups 6610, 6630 is less than the cup depth CD of the cups 6510, 6530 (FIG. 126 ). For example, the cup depth CD of the cups 6610, 6630 can be 0.2 millimeters less than the cup depth CD of the cups 6510, 6530. In certain instances, the cup depth CD of the cups 6610, 6630 can be 0.1 millimeters to 0.3 millimeters less than the cup depth CD of the cups 6510, 6530. The cup depth CD of the cups 6510, 6530 can be 25% to 50% greater than the cup depth CD of the cups 6610, 6630. For example, the cup depth CD of the cups 6510, 6530 can be 40% greater than the cup depth CD of the cups 6610, 6630. In various instances, the difference between the cup depth CD of the pocket forming arrangements 6500 and 6600 can be selected to be equal to, or substantially equal to, the diameter of a staple formed by the pocket forming arrangements 6500, 6600.

The depth profiles 6622, 6642 are curved profiles, which are devoid of linear portions. Moreover, the depth profiles 6622, 6642 can comprise one or more radii of curvature. In this instance, the depth profiles 6622, 6642 include more than one radius of curvature. Specifically, the depth profile 6622 of the proximal forming cup 6610 comprises an entry radius of curvature 6617 corresponding to the entry zone forming surface 6611 and an exit radius of curvature 6618 corresponding to the exit zone forming surface 6612. Similarly, the depth profile 6642 of the distal forming cup 6630 comprises an entry radius of curvature 6637 corresponding to the entry zone forming surface 6631 and an exit radius of curvature 6638 corresponding to the exit zone forming surface 6632. In this instance, the entry radii of curvature 6617, 6637 are larger than the exit radii of curvature 6618, 6638. Specific relationships between the entry and exit radii of curvature and various pocket features along with some potential advantages and patterns of the specific relationships are further described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,914.

The outer longitudinal edges of each cup 6610, 6630 are referred to as entry edges because they define the beginning of the entry zone forming surfaces 6611, 6631. The entry edges comprise an entry width which is the largest width of the forming surfaces of each cup 6610, 6630. The inner edges of each cup 6610, 6630 are referred to as exit edges because they define the end of the exit zone forming surfaces 6612, 6632. The exit edges comprise an exit width, also referred to as the bridge width BW (FIG. 135 ) which is the narrowest section of the forming surfaces of each cup 6610, 6630. A transition zone 6609, 6629 is positioned intermediate the entry zone and exit zone of each cup. The transition zones 6609, 6629 have a transition width which is less than the entry width but greater than the exit width. The transition zones 6609, 6629 include an inflection portion of the respective depth profiles 6622, 6642 and, thus, include the deepest portion of each cup 6610, 6630. In various instances, the transition zones 6609, 6629 comprise the majority of the length of each cup 6610, 6630. More specifically, the length of the transition zone 6609, 6629 can be greater than the combined length of the respective entry zone and exit zone of each cup 6610, 6630. The transition zones 6609, 6629 can extend along the tapered or narrowing section of each cup 6610, 6630. For example, each transition zone 6609, 6629 can extend inward from the widest section of the respective cup 6610, 6630 toward the bridge 6605.

FIG. 134 is a cross-sectional view of the distal forming cup 6630 taken along line 134-134 in FIG. 131 . This view is taken near the valley, or trough, of the distal forming cup 6630. This valley, or trough, is also the transition between the entry zone forming surface 6631 and the exit zone forming surface 6632. In various instances, the transition between entry and exit zones does not occur at the valley, or trough, of the cup. FIG. 135 illustrates a cross-sectional view of the distal forming cup 6630 taken along line 135-135 in FIG. 131 which is located within the exit zone forming surface 6632 of the forming cup 6630. FIG. 133 is a cross-sectional view of the distal forming cup 6630 taken along line 133-133 in FIG. 131 which is located within the entry zone forming surface 6632 of the distal forming cup 6630.

Referring primarily to FIGS. 133-135 , the pair of cup sidewalls 6633 of the distal forming cup 6630 includes a first sidewall 6633 a and a second sidewall 6633 b. The first and second sidewalls 6633 a, 6633 b are opposing sidewalls which extend toward each other from laterally-opposed sides of the distal forming cup 6630. The inflection surface, or bottom surface, 6634 of the distal forming cup 6630 is positioned between the first and second sidewalls 6633 a, 6633 b. The bottom surface 6634 of the distal forming cup 6630 is an entirely-curved, non-flat surface. In other words, the bottom surface 6634 is devoid of flat, planar surfaces. The bottom surface 6634 can define one or more radii of curvature. For example, at various longitudinal positions along the pocket axis 6603, the bottom surface 6634 defines different radii of curvature. A tangent to the bottom surface 6634 at the lateral center of the cup 6630 is parallel to the planar surface 6507 along the length thereof.

In various instances, the curvature of the bottom surface 6634 can be dimensioned such that the staple leg does not travel along a flat surface during the staple forming process. In such instances, the bottom surface 6643 can encourage staples to form into a more planar formed configuration than staples formed along flat bottom surfaces, especially when the staples are misaligned with the pocket axis 6603 during formation. The curvature of the bottom surface 6643 can be dimensioned such that the bottom surface 6643 provides a plurality of contact surfaces for the staple leg. For example, the radius of curvature of the bottom surface 6634 can be less than the radius of curvature of the staple leg.

The cup sidewalls 6613, 6633 are entirely-curved, non-flat surfaces. In other words, the cup sidewalls 6613, 6633 are devoid of flat, planar surfaces. Referring again to FIGS. 133-135 , the sidewalls 6633 a, 6633 b define one or more radii of curvature. For example, at various longitudinal positions along the pocket axis 6603, the sidewalls 6633 a, 6633 b define different radii of curvature. The entirely-curved contours of the cup sidewalls 6613, 6633 and the bottom surface 6634 can define curvilinear boundary surfaces of the cups 6610, 6630. The cups 6613, 6633 can be entirely-curved and devoid of flat, planar surfaces.

The sidewalls 6633 a, 6633 b are oriented at an entry angle θ₂ relative to the tissue-contacting surface 6507 at various transverse cross-sections of the distal forming cup 6630. More specifically, a tangent T to each sidewall 6633 a, 6633 b at the perimeter 6620 of the distal forming cup 6630 is oriented at the angle θ₂ relative to the tissue-contacting surface 6507 in FIGS. 133-135 . The entry angle θ₂ is constant within the transition forming surface zone 6629 (FIGS. 131 and 132 ) and along the majority of the length of the distal forming cup 6630. In various instances, the angle θ₂ can be between 55 degrees and 80 degrees, for example. For instance, in FIGS. 133-135 , the angle θ₂ is 80 degrees. In other instances, the angle θ₂ can be less than 55 degrees or more than 80 degrees. The sidewalls 6633 a, 6633 b are non-vertical sidewalls and, thus, the angle θ₂ of the tangent T along the perimeter 6620 can be less than 90 degrees, for example.

A datum point at the transition between the sidewalls 6633 a, 6633 b and the bottom surface 6634 is indicated for illustrative purposes in FIGS. 133-135 . For example, the curved boundary surface of the distal forming cup 6630 includes a datum point A at the transition between the sidewall 6633 a and the bottom surface 6634. At each longitudinal position along the cup 6630, the first sidewall 6633 a and the second sidewall 6633 b define a sidewall radius of curvature 6643 and the bottom surface 6634 defines a bottom radius of curvature 6644. The bottom radius of curvature 6644 can be different than the sidewall radius of curvature 6643. The transition between radii of curvature at the datum point A comprises a smooth, non-abrupt transition.

A datum line B is also depicted in FIGS. 133-135 for illustrative purposes. The datum line B extends between the first datum point A and the perimeter 6620 of the distal forming cup 6630. The datum line B is oriented at an angle θ₃ in FIGS. 133-135 . The angle θ₃ is constant within the transition forming surface zone 6629 (FIG. 132 ) and along the majority of the length of the distal forming cup 6630. In various instances, the angle θ₃ can be less than the angle θ₂. The angle θ₃ in FIGS. 133-135 is approximately 55 degrees, for example. In other instances, the angle θ₃ can be less than 55 degrees or more than 80 degrees. Though the angles θ₂ and θ₃ are constant along the length of the distal forming cup 6630, or at least along the substantial length of the distal forming cup 6630, the radius of curvature and the length of the arcs defining the sidewalls 6633 a, 6633 b varies as the depth and width of the distal forming cup 6630 varies along the length thereof.

The angle θ₂ relative to a tissue-contacting surface can comprise a relatively steep angle. For example, the angle θ₂ can be greater than the angles θ₁ and θ₃. The steepness of the angle θ₂ can encourage the staple to form along the pocket axis. A constant angle θ₂ can encourage a misaligned staple leg to move from the perimeter toward the lateral center or axis 6603 of the distal forming cup 6630. As described herein, the depth of the pocket can vary along the length thereof. However, maintaining a constant angle θ₂ can encourage a misaligned staple leg to move from the perimeter toward the lateral center of the distal forming cup 6630 even in shallower regions of the cup 6630.

Pocket arrangements having different cup depths CD can be dimensioned to have the same angles θ₂ and θ₃. For example, though the cup depth CD of the cups 6610, 6630 (FIG. 132 ) is less than the cup depth CD of the cups 6510, 6530 (FIG. 126 ), the angles θ₂ and θ₃ can be the same. In at least one instance, the angle θ₂ can be 80 degrees and the angle θ₃ can be 55 degrees for both forming pocket arrangements 6500 and 6600. In instances in which the tissue-contacting surface 6507 comprises a planar surface, the pocket forming arrangement 6600 can be configured to form staples to a reduced height in comparison to the pocket forming arrangement 6500. For example, a staple formed by the pocket forming arrangement 6600 can be shorter than an identical staple formed by the pocket forming arrangement 6500. In certain instances, variations to the formed height of the staples can be desirable to control the tissue compression and/or fluid flow between the anvil and the staple cartridge, for example. Though variations to the cup depth CD can be configured to control the formed height of the staples, maintaining constant entrance angles θ₂ along the length, or at least a substantial portion of the length, of the different cups can be configured to ensure that even the shorter formed staples are formed to a more consistent, planar configuration, which is desirable in certain instances.

FIGS. 143 and 144 depict a staple 6701 formed with the forming pocket arrangement 6600 (FIGS. 130-135 ) where the staple 6701 was aligned with the pocket axis 6603 of the forming pocket arrangement 6600 during the forming process. FIG. 143 depicts a top view of the staple 6701 in a fully-formed configuration and FIG. 144 depicts a side view of the staple 6701 in the fully-formed configuration. The staple includes a base 6702 and staple legs 6703 that extend from the base 6702. The base 6702 is aligned with the pocket axis 6603 and the tips 6704 of the staple legs 6703 strike the forming pocket arrangement 6600 along the pocket axis 6603.

The staple 6701 comprises a centerline CL (FIG. 144 ) which transects the base 6702 and extends vertically intermediate the unformed staple legs 6703. As the staple 6701 is formed to the fully-formed configuration, the tips 6704 of the staple legs 6703 are bent toward the centerline CL and toward the base 6702. The staple legs 6703 are formed such that the staple 6701 defines a height H (FIG. 144 ) when in the fully-formed configuration. The height H can be less than the height of the staple 6701 if it had been formed with the forming pocket arrangement 6500 (FIGS. 123-129 ) because the cup depth CD of the cups 6610, 6630 (FIG. 132 ) is less than the cup depth CD of the cups 6510, 6530 (FIG. 126 ).

To achieve the shorter height H, a portion of the staples legs 6703 can deflect laterally relative to the centerline CL and/or the tips 6704 of the staple legs 6702 can extend up to and/or below the base 6704. Comparatively, if the staple 6701 had been formed with the forming pocket arrangement 6500 having the deeper cup depth CD, the staple legs 6703 may not deflect laterally relative to the centerline CL and/or the tips 6704 of the staple legs 6702 may not overlap the base 6704 (see, e.g., staple 13100 (FIG. 121 )). Referring to FIG. 144 , a portion of each staple leg 6703 crosses the centerline CL and the tips 6704 of the staple legs 6702 extend past, or below, a tissue-compressing surface of the base 6702. Moreover, the staple 6701 comprises a first tip alignment axis TA1, a second tip alignment axis TA2, and a crown alignment axis CA. When aligned with the pocket axis 6603, the staple 6701 forms such that the first tip alignment axis TA1 and the second tip alignment axis TA2 are laterally offset and equidistant (D) from the crown alignment axis CA. The distance D can be approximately equal to the diameter of the staple 6701. As a result of the above, the staple 6701 assumes a substantially planar configuration; however, the tips 6704 are slightly overlapping and offset from the base 6702 to achieve the shorter height H.

FIG. 135A is a partial negative view of various slices of a forming pocket of the forming pocket arrangement 6600. The dimensions of the various slices are labeled thereon. The slices are of only a single sidewall of the forming pocket and are taken in planes along the forming pocket which are perpendicular to the tissue-contacting surface 6507 and the pocket axis 6603. Each slice comprises a width “x”, a height “y”, an upper radius of curvature “ra”, and a lower radius of curvature “rb”. The width “x” is defined as the x-component of the distance between the perimeter 6620 of the forming pocket and the bottom radius of curvature 6644 of the forming pocket. The height “y” is defined as the y-component of the distance between the perimeter 6620 of the forming pocket and the bottom radius of curvature 6644 of the forming pocket. The upper radius of curvature “ra” is defined as the radius of curvature of an upper portion of the sidewall. The lower radius of curvature “rb” is defined as the radius of curvature of an lower portion of the sidewall. Each dimension includes a number indicating which slice the dimension corresponds to. For example, Slice 1 includes a width “x₁”, a height “y₁”, an upper radius of curvature “ra₁”, and a lower radius of curvature “rb₁”. FIG. 135B is a table 6650 comprising the dimensions of the Slices 1-12 of FIG. 135A, in at least one embodiment.

FIG. 135C is a cross-sectional view of the forming pocket arrangement 6600 taken along the pocket axis 6603. FIG. 135C includes various dimensions of the distal forming pocket 6630 of forming pocket arrangement 6600. The length of the forming pocket 6630 is 1.90 mm, for example. The depth of the forming pocket 6630 is 0.30 mm, for example. In certain instances, the distal forming pocket 6630 comprises three radii of curvature: an entry radius of curvature which is 2.90 mm, a first exit radius of curvature which is 0.70 mm, and a second exit radius of curvature which is 0.10 mm, for example. The width of the bridge portion of the distal forming pocket 6630 is defined, in this instance, as the distance between the center of the forming pocket arrangement 6600 and the inner-most edge of the first exit radius of curvature (the edge of the first exit radius of curvature closest to the center of the forming pocket arrangement 6600) is 0.10 mm, for example. The bridge depth is 0.05 mm, for example.

FIGS. 136-142 depict a forming pocket arrangement 6800 that is configured to deform a staple during a surgical stapling procedure. The forming pocket arrangement 6800 comprises a proximal forming cup, or pocket, 6810 and a distal forming cup, or pocket, 6830 defined in a planar, or tissue-contacting, surface 6807 of an anvil 6801. The tissue-contacting surface 6807 of the anvil 6801 is configured to compress tissue against a staple cartridge when the anvil 6801 is clamped or closed relative to the staple cartridge. The forming pocket arrangement 6800 can be similar in many respects to the forming pocket arrangement 6500. For example, sidewalls of the staple-forming cups 6810, 6830 intersect the planar surface 6807 at a constant angle along the length thereof. Each cup 6810, 6830 is defined by a boundary surface as further described herein. The cups 6810, 6830 are aligned along a pocket axis 6803 of the forming pocket arrangement 6800. A staple is intended to be formed along the pocket axis 6803 by the forming pocket arrangement 6800 when deployed from a staple cartridge. In at least one such instance, a first leg of the staple can be formed by the proximal forming cup 6810 and a second leg of the staple can be formed by the distal forming cup 6830. In such instances, the first leg of the staple is aligned with a portion of the proximal forming cup 6810 and the second leg of the staple is aligned with a portion of the distal forming cup 6830 when the anvil 6801 is clamped relative to the staple cartridge.

Referring to FIGS. 137 and 138 , the forming pocket arrangement 6800 further comprises a bridge portion 6805 defined between the forming cups 6810, 6830. The bridge portion 6805 is recessed with respect to the planar surface 6807 of the anvil 6801; however, the bridge portion 6805 can be flush with the planar surface 6807 in other embodiments. The bridge portion 6805 comprises a bridge width BW and a bridge depth BD (FIG. 142 ). The bridge depth BD is the distance that the bottom portion of the bridge portion 6805 is recessed with respect to the planar surface 6807. The bridge width BW is the width of the pocket arrangement 6800 between the cups 6810, 6830. In this instance, the bridge width BW is the narrowest section of the forming surfaces of each cup 6810, 6830. The forming pocket arrangement 6800 comprises a center C (FIGS. 136 and 137 ) defined within the bridge portion 6805. The forming pocket arrangement 6800 is bilaterally symmetric with respect to the bridge portion 6805, bilaterally symmetric with respect to pocket axis 6803, and rotationally symmetric with respect to the center C.

The forming pocket arrangement 6800 further comprises a pair of primary sidewalls 6808 extending from the planar surface 6807 of the anvil 6801 toward the cups 6810, 6830 and the bridge portion 6805. The primary sidewalls 6808 are angled at angle θ₁ (FIG. 139 ) with respect to the planar surface 6807 of the anvil 6801. The cups 6810, 6830 define a perimeter 6820 and the inner edges of the primary sidewalls 6808 extend between the planar surface 6807 and the perimeter 6820 of the cups 6810, 6830. Referring primarily to FIG. 137 , the inner edges of the primary sidewalls 6808 are curved, or contoured, with respect to the cups 6810, 6830. In certain instances, the forming pocket arrangement 6800 may not include the primary sidewalls 6808. In such instances, the cups 6810, 6830 can extend directly to the planar surface 6807 and the perimeter 6820 of the cups 6810, 6830 can be defined in the planar surface 6807.

Referring again to FIGS. 137 and 138 , the proximal forming cup 6810 comprises a pair of cup sidewalls 6813 and the distal forming cup 6830 comprises a pair of cup sidewalls 6833. The cup sidewalls 6813, 6833 comprise curved, or contoured, profiles and are configured to direct the staple tips and the legs of the staples toward the forming surfaces of the cups 6810, 6830 as well as help control the forming process of the staples. The sidewalls 6813, 6833 extend from the primary sidewalls 6808 and the planar surface 6807 toward the forming surfaces of each cup 6810, 6830. The sidewalls 6813, 6833 are configured to encourage the staple tips and/or the legs of the staples to form along the pocket axis 6803 as the staples are formed against the forming surfaces of the cups 6810, 6830. Collectively, the primary sidewalls 6808 and the cup sidewalls 6813, 6833 cooperate to funnel corresponding staple tips toward the lateral center of each cup 6810, 6830. An inflection surface, or bottom surface, 6814, 6834 extends along the lateral center of each respective cup 6810, 6830 intermediate the respective sidewalls 6813, 6833.

Referring still to FIG. 137 , the forming surfaces of the cups 6810, 6830 comprise an entry zone forming surface 6811, 6831, respectively, and an exit zone forming surface 6812, 6832, respectively. The entry zone forming surfaces 6811, 6831 can coincide with less aggressive channeling portions of the sidewalls 6813, 6833. Similarly, the exit zone forming surfaces 6812, 6832 can coincide with more aggressive channeling portions of the sidewalls 6813, 6833.

Referring primarily now to FIG. 138 , the forming surfaces of each cup 6810, 6830 are defined by a depth profile or contour. The proximal forming cup 6810 includes the depth profile 6822, and the distal forming cup 6830 includes the depth profile 6842. The depth profiles 6822, 6842 define the depth of the cups 6810, 6830, respectively, along the length thereof. The cups 6810, 6830 reach a maximum cup depth CD within their respective transition zone 6809, 6829, which are further described below. The cup depth CD of the pockets 6810, 6830 can be between 0.4 and 0.6 millimeters, for example. For instance, the cup depth CD can be 0.5 millimeters. In other instances, the cup depth CD can be less than 0.4 millimeters or more than 0.6 millimeters.

The depth profiles 6822, 6842 are curved profiles which are devoid of linear portions. Moreover, the depth profiles 6822, 6842 can comprise one or more radii of curvature. In this instance, the depth profiles 6822, 6842 include more than one radius of curvature. Specifically, the depth profile 6822 of the proximal forming cup 6810 comprises an entry radius of curvature 6817 corresponding to the entry zone forming surface 6811 and an exit radius of curvature 6818 corresponding to the exit zone forming surface 6812. Similarly, the depth profile 6842 of the distal forming cup 6830 comprises an entry radius of curvature 6837 corresponding to the entry zone forming surface 6831 and an exit radius of curvature 6838 corresponding to the exit zone forming surface 6832. In this instance, the entry radii of curvature 6817, 6837 are larger than the exit radii of curvature 6818, 6838. Specific relationships between the entry and exit radii of curvature and various pocket features along with some potential advantages and patterns of the specific relationships are further described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/385,914.

The outer longitudinal edges of each cup 6810, 6830 are referred to as entry edges because they define the beginning of the entry zone forming surfaces 6811, 6831. The entry edges comprise an entry width which is the largest width of the forming surfaces of each cup 6810, 6830. The inner edges of each cup 6810, 6830 are referred to as exit edges because they define the end of the exit zone forming surfaces 6812, 6832. The exit edges comprise an exit width, also referred to as the bridge width BW (FIG. 142 ) which is the narrowest section of the forming surfaces of each cup 6810, 6830. A transition zone 6809, 6829 is positioned intermediate the entry zone and exit zone of each cup. The transition zones 6809, 6829 have a transition width which is less than the entry width but greater than the exit width. The transition zones 6809, 6829 include an inflection portion of the respective depth profiles 6822, 6842 and, thus, include the deepest portion of each cup 6810, 6830. In various instances, the transition zones 6809, 6829 comprise the majority of the length of each cup 6810, 6830. More specifically, the length of the transition zone 6809, 6829 can be greater than the combined length of the respective entry zone and exit zone of each cup 6810, 6830. The transition zones 6809, 6829 can extend along the tapered or narrowing section of each cup 6810, 6830. For example, each transition zone 6809, 6829 can extend inward from the widest section of the respective cup 6810, 6830 toward the bridge 6805.

FIG. 141 is a cross-sectional view of the distal forming cup 6830 taken along line 141-141 in FIG. 137 . This view is taken near the valley, or trough, of the distal forming cup 6830. This valley, or trough, is also the transition between the entry zone forming surface 6831 and the exit zone forming surface 6832. In various instances, the transition between entry and exit zones does not occur at the valley, or trough, of the cup. FIG. 142 illustrates a cross-sectional view of the distal forming cup 6830 taken along line 142-142 in FIG. 137 which is located within the exit zone forming surface 6832 of the forming cup 6830. FIG. 139 is a cross-sectional view of the distal forming cup 6830 taken along line 139-139 in FIG. 137 , and FIG. 140 is a cross-sectional view of the distal forming cup 6830 taken along line 140-140 in FIG. 137 , which are both within the entry zone forming surface 6832 of the distal forming cup 6830.

Referring primarily to FIGS. 139-142 , the pair of cup sidewalls 6833 of the distal forming cup 6830 includes a first sidewall 6833 a and a second sidewall 6833 b. The first and second sidewalls 6833 a, 6833 b are opposing sidewalls which extend toward each other from laterally-opposed sides of the distal forming cup 6830. The inflection surface, or bottom surface, 6834 of the distal forming cup 6830 is positioned between the first and second sidewalls 6833 a, 6833 b. The bottom surface 6834 of the distal forming cup 6830 is an entirely-curved, non-flat surface. In other words, the bottom surface 6834 is devoid of flat, planar surfaces. The bottom surface 6834 can define one or more radii of curvature. For example, at various longitudinal positions along the pocket axis 6803, the bottom surface 6834 defines different radii of curvature. A tangent to the bottom surface 6834 at the lateral center of the cup 6830 is parallel to the planar surface 6807 along the length thereof.

In various instances, the curvature of the bottom surface 6834 can be dimensioned such that the staple leg does not travel along a flat surface during the staple forming process. In such instances, the bottom surface 6843 can encourage staples to form into a more planar formed configuration than staples formed with flat bottom surfaces, especially when the staples are misaligned with the pocket axis 6803 during formation. The curvature of the bottom surface 6843 can be dimensioned such that the bottom surface 6843 provides a plurality of contact surfaces for the staple leg. For example, the radius of curvature of the bottom surface 6834 can be less than the radius of curvature of the staple leg.

The cup sidewalls 6813, 6833 are entirely-curved, non-flat surfaces. In other words, the cup sidewalls 6813, 6833 are devoid of flat, planar surfaces. The sidewalls 6833 a, 6833 b define one or more radii of curvature. For example, at various longitudinal positions along the pocket axis 6803, the sidewalls 6833 a, 6833 b define different radii of curvature. The entirely-curved contours of the cup sidewalls 6813, 6833 and the bottom surface 6834 can define curvilinear boundary surfaces of the cups 6810, 6830. The cups 6813, 6833 can be entirely-curved and devoid of flat, planar surfaces.

The sidewalls 6833 a, 6833 b are oriented at an entry angle θ₂ relative to the tissue-contacting surface 6807 at various transverse cross-sections of the distal forming cup 6830. More specifically, a tangent T to each sidewall 6833 a, 6833 b at the perimeter 6820 of the distal forming cup 6830 is oriented at the angle θ₂ relative to the tissue-contacting surface 6807 in FIGS. 139-142 . The entry angle θ₂ is constant within the transition forming surface zone 6829 (FIGS. 137 and 139 ) and along the majority of the length of the distal forming cup 6830. In various instances, the angle θ₂ can be between 55 degrees and 80 degrees, for example. For instance, in FIGS. 139-142 , the angle θ₂ is 80 degrees. In other instances, the angle θ₂ can be less than 55 degrees or more than 80 degrees. The sidewalls 6833 a, 6833 b are non-vertical sidewalls and, thus, the angle θ₂ of the tangent T along the perimeter 6820 can be less than 90 degrees, for example.

A datum point at the transition between the sidewalls 6833 a, 6833 b and the bottom surface 6834 is indicated for illustrative purposes in FIGS. 139-142 . For example, the curved boundary surface of the distal forming cup 6830 includes a datum point A at the transition between the sidewall 6833 a and the bottom surface 6834. At each longitudinal position along the cup 6530, the first sidewall 6833 a and the second sidewall 6833 b define a sidewall radius of curvature 6843 and the bottom surface 6834 defines a bottom radius of curvature 6844. The bottom radius of curvature 6844 can be different than the sidewall radius of curvature 6843. The transition between radii of curvature at the datum point A comprises a smooth, non-abrupt transition.

A datum line B is also depicted in FIGS. 139-142 for illustrative purposes. The datum line B extends between the first datum point A and the perimeter 6820 of the distal forming cup 6830. The datum line B is oriented at an angle θ₃ in FIGS. 139-142 . The angle θ₃ changes along the length of the distal forming cup 6830. In various instances, the angle θ₃ can be less than the angle θ₂ along the length of the distal forming cup 6830. The angle θ₃ can increase then decrease as the sidewalls 6833 a, 6833 b extend inward toward the center C. For example, the angle θ₃ can increase from the entry edge of the cup 6830 toward the transition zone 6829, remain constant within the transition zone 6829, and decrease from the transition zone 6829 toward the exit edges of the cup 6830. In the depicted embodiment, the angle θ₃ is 45 degrees in FIG. 139 , the angle θ_(3′) is 55 degrees in FIG. 140 , the angle θ_(3″) is 70 degrees in FIG. 141 , and the angle θ_(3′″) is 55 degrees in FIG. 142 , for example. Though the angles θ₂ and θ₃ are constant within the transition zone 6829 of the distal forming cup 6830, the radius of curvature and the length of the arcs defining the sidewalls 6833 a, 6833 b varies as the depth and width of the distal forming cup 6830 varies along the length thereof.

The angle θ₂ relative to a tissue-contacting surface can comprise a relatively steep angle. For example, the angle θ₂ can be greater than the variable angle θ₃. The steepness of the angle θ₂ can encourage the staple to form along the pocket axis. A constant angle θ₂ can encourage a misaligned staple leg to move from the perimeter toward the lateral center of the cup. In various instances, the angle θ₂ can be constant and steep within the exit zone, which can improve staple formation quality. Additionally or alternatively, the angle θ₂ can be constant in the transition zone. As described herein, the depth of the pocket can vary along the length thereof. However, maintaining a constant angle θ₂ can encourage a misaligned staple leg to move from the perimeter toward the lateral center of the cup even in shallower regions of the cup. Furthermore, the maximum cup depth CD in certain anvils can vary between pockets in the anvil. For example, different depths can be utilized to form staples to different heights and/or to form staples driven by drivers having different heights, as further described herein. In such instances, a constant angle θ₂ can encourage the staples formed by the shallower pockets to form along the pocket axis.

In certain instances, an anvil for a surgical end effector can include staple forming pockets of different depths. For example, the depth of staple forming pockets can vary between rows of forming pockets and/or longitudinally along the length of a row of forming pockets. Such depth differences can be selected to accommodate variations in the displacement of staple drivers within a staple cartridge during a staple firing stroke, variations in the overdrive distance of the fired staples, and/or the position of the anvil relative to the staple cartridge. Additionally or alternatively, depth differences between staple forming pockets can correspond to different tissue gaps between stepped tissue compression surfaces on the anvil and/or a staple cartridge. For example, to form staples to the same formed height when the staples are driven by drivers having different lift lengths that result in different amounts of staple overdrive, a depth difference between staple forming pockets can be selected that corresponds to the different stroke lengths and the different amounts of staple overdrive. In other instances, different depth staple forming pockets in an anvil can be selected to form staples to different formed heights, which may be desirable in certain instances to vary the compression of stapled tissue and/or to accommodate for variations in tissue thickness.

FIG. 142A is a partial negative view of various slices of a forming pocket of the forming pocket arrangement 6800. The dimensions of the various slices are labeled thereon. The slices are of only a single sidewall of the forming pocket and are taken in planes along the forming pocket which are perpendicular to the tissue-contacting surface 6807 and the pocket axis 6803. Each slice comprises a width “x”, a height “y”, an upper radius of curvature “ra”, and a lower radius of curvature “rb”. The width “x” is defined as the x-component of the distance between the perimeter 6820 of the forming pocket and the bottom radius of curvature 6844 of the forming pocket. The height “y” is defined as the y-component of the distance between the perimeter 6820 of the forming pocket and the bottom radius of curvature 6844 of the forming pocket. The upper radius of curvature “ra” is defined as the radius of curvature of an upper portion of the sidewall. The lower radius of curvature “rb” is defined as the radius of curvature of an lower portion of the sidewall. Each dimension includes a number indicating which slice the dimension corresponds to. For example, Slice 1 includes a width “x₁”, a height “y₁”, an upper radius of curvature “ra₁”, and a lower radius of curvature “rb₁”. FIG. 142B is a table 6850 comprising the dimensions of the Slices 1-12 of FIG. 142A, in at least one embodiment.

FIG. 142C is a cross-sectional view of the forming pocket arrangement 6800 taken along the pocket axis 6803. FIG. 142C includes various dimensions of the distal forming pocket 6830 of forming pocket arrangement 6800. The length of the forming pocket 6830 is 1.90 mm, for example. The depth of the forming pocket 6830 is 0.50 mm, for example. In certain instances, the distal forming pocket 6830 comprises three radii of curvature: an entry radius of curvature which is 1.40 mm, a first exit radius of curvature which is 0.80 mm, and a second exit radius of curvature which is 0.10 mm, for example. The width of the bridge portion of the distal forming pocket 6830 is defined, in this instance, as the distance between the center of the forming pocket arrangement 6800 and the inner-most edge of the first exit radius of curvature (the edge of the first exit radius of curvature closest to the center of the forming pocket arrangement 6800) is 0.10 mm, for example. The bridge depth is 0.15 mm, for example.

Referring now to FIG. 145 , a surgical end effector 7000 comprising an anvil 7001 and a staple cartridge 7060 having a plurality of staples 7080 is depicted. The end effector 7000 is in a closed, or clamped, position. More specifically, the anvil 7001 can be pivoted relative to the staple cartridge 7060 to move the end effector 7000 to the closed position and clamp tissue between the anvil 7001 and the staple cartridge 7060. In other instances, the anvil 7001 can be fixed and the staple cartridge 7060 can pivot relative to the anvil 7001 to move the end effector 7000 to the closed position and, in still other instances, both the anvil 7001 and the staple cartridge 7060 can be configured to pivot to move the end effector 7000 toward the closed position.

In the closed position, a uniform tissue gap TG is defined between the staple cartridge 7060 and the anvil 7001. In other words, the tissue gap TG is constant laterally across the end effector 7000. The staple cartridge 7060 includes a planar, or substantially flat, tissue compression surface, or deck, 7062, and the anvil 7001 also includes a planar, or substantially flat, tissue compression surface 7007. Neither the deck 7062 of the staple cartridge 7060 nor the tissue compression surface 7007 of the anvil 7001 includes a stepped surface having longitudinal steps between adjacent longitudinal portions. In other instances, as described herein, the deck of a staple cartridge and/or the tissue compression surface of an anvil can include a stepped profile.

The staple cartridge 7060 includes a staple cartridge body 7064 having a longitudinal slot 7065 and a plurality of staple cavities 7066 defined therein. The slot 7065 extends along a central, longitudinal axis of the staple cartridge 7060. Each staple cavity 7066 comprises an opening in the deck 7062. The staple cavities 7066 are arranged in a plurality of longitudinally extending rows 7068 including a first row, or outer row, 7068 a, a second row, or intermediate row, 7068 b, and a third row, or inner row, 7068 c on each side of the slot 7065. In other instances, the staple cartridge 7060 can have fewer than or more than six rows of staple cavities 7066. For example, a staple cartridge can have two staple cavity rows on each side of the longitudinal slot 7065.

A staple 7080 is removably stored in each staple cavity 7066, and each staple 7080 is supported by a staple driver 7070. In various instances, a staple driver 7070 can support and fire more than one staple 7080. For example, a driver may be configured to simultaneously fire staples from adjacent rows of staple cavities in a staple cartridge. The deck 7062 includes cavity extenders 7061 that protrude from the deck 7062 toward the tissue compression surface 7007 of the anvil 7001. The cavity extenders 7061 are positioned around at least a portion of the staple cavities 7066 and can guide the staples 7080 above the deck 7062. The cavities extenders 7061 can also be configured to engage or grip tissue and/or support the staples 7080 and/or the drivers 7070 during firing. In other instances, the deck 7062 can be devoid of cavity extenders and can comprise a smooth tissue-contacting surface, for example.

The staples 7080 in FIG. 145 are depicted in a formed configuration in which the staples 7080 fired from the cavities 7066 across the rows 7068 a, 7068 b, 7068 c on both sides of the slot 7065 have been formed to the same height H. Forming staples to a uniform height can tightly cinch the tissue and reduce bleeding therefrom.

The drivers 7070 are movably positioned in the cavities 7066. During a firing stroke, a firing member is configured to lift the drivers 7070 toward the anvil 7001, which drives the staples 7080 supported on the drivers 7070 into forming engagement with the anvil 7001. Each staple 7080 is driven into forming contact with a staple forming pocket arrangement 7002, 7004 defined in the planar surface 7007 of the anvil 7001. The staple forming pocket arrangements 7002, 7004 are arranged in a plurality of longitudinally extending rows 7003 including a first row, or outer row, 7003 a, a second row, or intermediate row, 7003 b, and a third row, or inner row, 7003 c on both lateral sides of the anvil 7001. Each row of staple cavities 7066 is aligned with a row 7003 of staple forming pocket arrangements 7002, 7004. As described with respect to various staple forming pockets arrangements disclosed herein, the staple forming pocket arrangements 7002, 7004 can each include a pair of forming pockets or cups, e.g., a proximal cup and a distal cup, and each cup can be positioned to receive a staple leg when the staple 7080 is driven into forming contact with the anvil 7001.

The anvil 7001 includes two different staple forming pocket arrangements. More specifically, the anvil 7001 includes a first staple forming pocket arrangement 7002 comprising a first geometry and a second staple forming pocket arrangement 7004 comprising a second geometry. The first staple forming pocket arrangements 7002 are aligned with the outermost row 7068 a of staple cavities 7066 on both sides of the slot 7065, and the second staple forming pocket arrangements 7004 are aligned with the rows 7068 b, 7068 c of staple cavities 7066 on both sides of the slot 7065. The cups of the first staple forming pocket arrangement 7002 define a cup depth CD₁ relative to the anvil planar surface 7007 and the cups of the second staple forming pocket arrangement 7004 define a cup depth CD₂ relative to the anvil planar surface 7007. The cup depth CD₁ of the outer staple forming pocket arrangements 7002 is greater than the cup depth CD₂ of the inner staple forming pocket arrangements 7004. As a result, the deeper staple forming pockets of the first arrangement 7002 are positioned laterally outboard of the shallower staple forming pockets of the second arrangement 7004, although any suitable arrangement can be used.

In various instances, the first staple forming pocket arrangements 7002 can be the same as or similar to the staple forming pocket arrangement 6800 (FIGS. 136-142 ) and the second staple forming pocket arrangements 7004 can be the same as or similar to the staple forming pocket arrangement 6600 (FIGS. 130-136 ). Though the depth of the cups is different between the first forming pocket arrangement 7002 and the second forming pocket arrangement 7004, the sidewalls of the cups can intersect the planar surface 7007 at the same angle, i.e., a tangent to the sidewalls can be maintained at constant entry angle, along the length of the cups in each arrangement 7002, 7004 or at least along the majority of the length of the cups in each arrangement 7002, 7004. As described herein, a steep constant angle sidewall is configured to facilitate planar formation of the staples 7080, including staples that are misaligned with the central axis of the arrangement 7002, 7004.

In the fired position depicted in FIG. 145 , the staples 7080 have been overdriven with respect to the staple cartridge body 7064. More specifically, the staple-supporting surface of each driver 7070 has been driven past the staple cartridge body 7064 such that the staples 7080 are completely removed from the cartridge body 7064 during firing. When overdriven, the cradle, or bottommost surface, of each staple 7080 is positioned above the deck 7062 and/or above the cavity extenders 7061 protruding from the deck 7062. The overdrive feature of the drivers 7070 can be configured to fully eject the fired staples 7080 from the staple cartridge 7060 and to facilitate the release of stapled tissue from the end effector 7000, for example. Stated another way, the overdrive feature of the drivers 7070 can push the tissue away from the deck 7067

In various instances, different staples can be overdriven by different amounts. For example, the staples 7080 fired from the outer rows 7068 a of staple cavities 7066 are overdriven a first distance D₁ relative to the deck surface 7062 and the staples 7080 fired from the intermediate and inner rows 7068 b, 7068 c of staple cavities 7066 are overdriven a second distance D₂ relative to the deck surface 7062. The distances D₁ and D₂ in FIG. 145 are the distances between the cradle of the staples 7080 and the planar deck surface 7062. In other instances, the overdrive distance can be measured between the support surfaces of the staple cradles and the uppermost surface of the adjacent cavity extenders 7061.

To achieve the different overdrive distances D₁ and D₂ in FIG. 145 , the stroke length of the drivers 7070 can be different. For example, the firing element can be configured to lift the drivers 7070 supporting staples 7080 in the outer rows 7068 a a first distance and the drivers 7070 supporting the staples 7080 in the inner rows 7068 b, 7068 c a second distance. In certain instances, the geometry of the sled can be selected to control the different stroke lengths of the drivers 7070. Additionally or alternatively, the geometry of the drivers 7070, such as the driver's height, for example, can be selected to control the different overdrive distances.

For each formed staple 7080 in FIG. 145 , the sum of the tissue gap and the cup depth is equal to the sum of the overdrive distance and the staple height. For example:

TG+CD₁ =D ₁ +H;

and

TG+CD₂ =D ₂ +H.

Stated differently, for each formed staple, the height of the staple H equals the tissue gap TG plus the cup depth CD minus the overdrive distance D.

H=TG+CD₁ −D ₁;

and

H=TG+CD₂ −D ₂.

In instances in which the height of the staple H and the tissue gap TG are constant laterally across the end effector 7000, as depicted in FIG. 145 , the different cup depths correspond to different overdrive distances. For example, to ensure the anvil 7001 is compatible with the staple cartridge 7060, the staple forming pocket arrangements 7002, 7004 and cup depths CD₁, CD₂ thereof can be selected to accommodate the different overdrive distances D₁, D₂. For example, the difference between the cup depth CD₁ and the cup depth CD₂ can be configured to accommodate the difference in overdrive distances D₁ and D₂:

CD₁−CD₂ =D ₁ −D ₂.

More specifically, if the difference between the overdrive distances D₁ and D₂ is 0.38 millimeters, for example, the difference between the cup depths CD₁ and CD₂ can also be 0.38 millimeters. In certain instances, the difference in overdrive distances and cup depths can be between 0.2 millimeters and 1 millimeter, for example. The corresponding difference between the overdrive distances D₁ and D₂ and the cup depths CD₁ and CD₂ is configured to form the staples 7080 to the same formed height H laterally across the end effector 7000. Regardless of the cup depth, the sidewalls of the cups can be designed to intersect the tissue compression surface 7007 of the anvil 7001 at a constant angle to encourage the planar formation of the staples 7080, including misaligned staples, as further described herein.

In certain instances, surgical instruments and/or subassemblies thereof can be modular. Different types of staple cartridges can be compatible with more than one anvil and/or different types of anvils can be compatible with more than one staple cartridge. For example, the staple cartridge 7060, which is compatible with the anvil 7001 having a flat tissue compression surface 7007 (see, e.g. FIG. 145 ) can also be compatible with a stepped anvil. An end effector that includes the staple cartridge 7060 and a compatible stepped anvil can define a laterally variable tissue gap TG; however, such an end effector can still be configured to form staples to a constant formed height. In such instances, the different overdrive distances D₁ and D₂ can correspond to different heights of an anvil's stepped tissue compression surface.

Referring now to FIG. 146 , an end effector 7100 is depicted with the staple cartridge 7060 and an anvil 7101. The end effector 7100 is in a closed or clamped position. In use, the anvil 7101 can be pivoted relative to the staple cartridge 7060 to move the end effector 7100 to the closed position and clamp tissue between the anvil 7101 and the staple cartridge 7060. In other instances, the anvil 7101 can be fixed and the staple cartridge 7060 can pivot relative to the anvil 7101 to move the end effector 7100 to the closed position and, in still other instances, both the anvil 7101 and the staple cartridge 7060 can be configured to pivot the end effector 7100 toward the closed position.

The anvil 7101 includes a stepped tissue compression surface 7107 having longitudinal steps between adjacent longitudinal portions. More specifically, the anvil 7101 includes a plurality of longitudinal portions 7110 including a first portion, or outer portion, 7110 a and a second portion, or inner portion, 7110 b on each lateral side of the anvil 7101. A step 7112 is positioned between the outer portion 7100 a and the inner portion 7100 b. The step 7112 extends parallel to rows of staple forming pocket arrangements 7102 defined in the surface 7107 and extends along an axis positioned intermediate adjacent rows of staple forming pocket arrangements 7102.

The step 7112 comprises a height H_(step), which corresponds to the height difference between the first longitudinal portion 7110 a and the second longitudinal portion 7110 b of the tissue compression surface 7107. Because the staple cartridge 7060 includes a non-stepped deck 7062, the height H_(step) corresponds to the variation in tissue gap between the staple cartridge 7060 and the anvil 7101 when the end effector 7100 is in the closed position. A first tissue gap TG₁ is defined between the first portion 7110 a and the staple cartridge 7060 and a second tissue gap TG₂ is defined between the second portion 7110 b and the staple cartridge 7060. The tissue gap TG₁ is greater than the tissue gap TG₂. It can be desirable to provide greater tissue compression adjacent to the slot 7065 and/or along the inner portion 7110 b of the anvil 7101 than along the lateral sides of the end effector 7100. In other instances, the anvil 7101 can include additional longitudinal portions having steps therebetween and, in such instances, may define additional, different tissue gaps when the end effector 7100 is in the closed position.

The staples 7080 in FIG. 146 are depicted in the formed configuration in which the staples 7080 fired from the rows 7068 a, 7068 b, 7068 c of staple cavities 7066 on both sides of the slot 7065 have been formed to the same height H. During a staple firing stroke, a firing member is configured to lift the drivers 7070 toward the anvil 7101, which drives the staples 7080 supported on the drivers 7070 into forming engagement with the anvil 7101. More specifically, each staple 7080 is driven into forming contact with one of the staple forming pocket arrangements 7102 defined in the tissue compression surface 7107 of the anvil 7101. The staple forming pocket arrangements 7102 are arranged in a plurality of longitudinally extending rows 7103 including a first row, or outer row, 7103 a, a second row, or intermediate row, 7103 b, and a third row, or inner row, 7103 c on both sides of the anvil 7101. The first longitudinal portion 7110 a includes the first row 7103 a, and the second longitudinal portion 7110 b includes the second and third rows 7103 b, 7103 c. Each row 7068 of staple cavities 7066 is aligned with a row 7103 of staple forming pocket arrangements 7102. As described with respect to the various staple forming pockets arrangements disclosed herein, each staple forming pocket arrangement 7102 includes a pair of forming pockets or cups, e.g., a proximal cup and a distal cup, and each cup is positioned to receive a staple leg when the staple 7080 is driven into forming contact with the anvil 7101.

The staple forming pocket arrangements 7102 define a cup depth CD relative to the tissue compression surface 7107. In various instances, the staple forming pocket arrangements 7102 are the same as or similar to the staple forming pocket arrangement 6600 (FIGS. 130-135 ). In such instances, the sidewalls of the cups can intersect the tissue compression surface 7107 at a constant angle, i.e., a tangent to the sidewalls can be maintained at constant entry angle, along the length of the cups or at least along the majority of the length of the cups. A steep constant angle sidewall along the length of the cups is configured to facilitate planar formation of the staples 7080, including staples that are misaligned with the central axis of the staple forming arrangement 7102.

For each formed staple 7080 in FIG. 146 , the sum of the tissue gap and the cup depth is equal to the sum of the overdrive distance and the staple height. For example:

TG₁+CD=D ₁ +H;

and

TG₂+CD=D ₂ +H.

Stated differently, for each formed staple, the height of the staple H equals the tissue gap TG plus the cup depth CD minus the overdrive distance D.

H=TG₁+CD−D ₁;

and

H=TG₂+CD−D ₂.

In instances in which the height H of the staple and the cup depth CD are constant laterally across the end effector 7100, as depicted in FIG. 146 , the height of the tissue compression surface 7107 can vary, i.e., define a stepped profile, which corresponds to the different overdrive distances. For example, the difference between the tissue gap TG₁ and the tissue gap TG₂ can be configured to accommodate the difference in overdrive distances D₁ and D₂:

TG₁−TG₂ =D ₁ −D ₂.

Stated differently, the height H_(step) of the step 7112 between the longitudinal portions 7110 a, 7110 b can be equal to the difference in overdrive distances D₁ and D₂:

H _(step) =D ₁ −D ₂.

For example, if the difference between the overdrive distances D₁ and D₂ is 0.38 millimeters, the height H_(step) of the step 7112 can also be 0.38 millimeters, for example. In certain instances, the difference in overdrive distances and the tissue gap can be between 0.2 millimeters and 1 millimeter. Corresponding difference between the overdrive distances D₁ and D₂ and the height of the longitudinal portions 7110 a, 7110 b can be configured to form the staples 7080 to the same formed height H laterally across the end effector 7100.

Above certain threshold loads, the anvil 7101 may be prone to bending along the step 7112 such that the tissue gap along the lateral sides of the anvil 7101 is greater than the tissue gap TG₁ depicted in FIG. 146 . As a result, the anvil 7001 (FIG. 145 ) may be stiffer than the anvil 7101 because the anvil 7001 comprises a planar, or non-stepped, tissue compression surface 7007. The anvil 7001 can be more rigid and, thus, less prone to bending and/or deflecting when subjected to high compression loads during clamping and/or firing.

In various instances, it can be desirable to utilize an anvil having a planar, or non-stepped, tissue compression surface, such as the anvil 7001, to minimize deflection of the anvil along the lateral sides thereof. In certain instances, a variable tissue gap can also be desirable to control tissue flow and/or the quantity of tissue compressed and ultimately captured by the end effector. For example, a smaller outer tissue gap and larger inner tissue gap can allow the end effector to capture a greater quantity of tissue adjacent to the cutline, which may improve hemostasis. The smaller outside tissue gap may improve control over tissue flow and ensure that the lateral sides of the end effector effectively grip and engage the target tissue. Moreover, the larger inside tissue gap may allow the end effector to capture a larger, e.g., thicker, piece of tissue.

An exemplary variable tissue gap end effector 7200 is depicted in FIG. 147 . The end effector 7200 includes the anvil 7001 having a planar, or non-stepped, tissue compression surface 7007 (see also FIG. 145 ) and a staple cartridge 7260 having a stepped deck 7262. Though the tissue gap varies laterally across the end effector 7200, the end effector 7200 can be configured to form staples 7280 to a constant formed height. For example, different staple overdrive distances can correspond to the different tissue gaps and/or different staple forming arrangements having different cup depths, as further described herein.

Referring still to FIG. 147 , the end effector 7200 is in a closed or clamped position. In use, the anvil 7001 can be pivoted relative to the staple cartridge 7260 to move the end effector 7200 to the closed position and clamp tissue between the anvil 7001 and the staple cartridge 7260. In other instances, the anvil 7001 can be fixed and the staple cartridge 7260 can pivot relative to the anvil 7001 to move the end effector 7200 to the closed position and, in still other instances, both the anvil 7001 and the staple cartridge 7260 can be configured to pivot to move the end effector 7200 toward the closed position.

The staple cartridge 7260 includes a staple cartridge body 7264 having a longitudinal slot 7265 and a plurality of staple cavities 7266 defined therein. Staples 7280 are moveably positioned in the staple cavities 7266. The slot 7265 can extend along a central, longitudinal axis of the staple cartridge 7260. Each staple cavity 7266 comprises an opening in the deck 7262. The staple cavities 7266 are arranged in a plurality of longitudinally extending rows 7268 including a first row, or outer row, 7268 a, a second row, or intermediate row, 7268 b, and a third row, or inner row, 7268 c on each side of the slot 7265. In other instances, the staple cartridge 7260 can have fewer than or more than six rows of staple cavities 7266. For example, a staple cartridge can have two staple cavity rows on each side of a longitudinal slot.

Each staple 7280 is supported by a staple driver 7270. In various instances, a staple driver 7270 can support and fire more than one staple 7280. For example, a driver may be configured to fire staples from adjacent rows of staple cavities in a staple cartridge. The deck 7262 includes cavity extenders 7261 that protrude from the deck 7262 toward the tissue compression surface 7007 of the anvil 7001. The cavity extenders 7261 are positioned around at least a portion of the staple cavities 7266 and can guide the staples as they are ejected from the staple cavities 7266. The cavities extenders 7261 may also be configured to engage or grip tissue and/or support the staples 7280 and/or the drivers 7270 during firing, for example. In other instances, the deck 7262 can be devoid of cavity extenders and can comprise a smooth tissue-contacting surface, for example.

The staples 7280 in FIG. 147 are depicted in a formed configuration in which the staples 7280 fired from the cavities 7266 across the rows 7268 a, 7268 b, 7268 c on both sides of the slot 7265 have been formed to the same height H. In certain instances, it can be advantageous to form staples across multiple rows to tightly cinch the tissue and reduce bleeding therefrom.

The drivers 7270 are movably positioned in the cavities 7266. During a firing stroke, a firing member is configured to lift the drivers 7270 toward the anvil 7001, which drives the staples 7280 supported on the drivers 7070 into forming engagement with the anvil 7001. Each staple 7280 is driven into forming contact with a staple forming pocket arrangement 7002, 7004. Each row 7268 of staple cavities 7266 is aligned with a row 7003 of staple forming pocket arrangements 7002, 7004. The first staple forming pocket arrangements 7002 are aligned with the outermost row 7268 a of staple cavities 7266 on each side of the slot 7265, and the second staple forming pocket arrangements 7004 are aligned with the innermost rows 7268 b, 7268 c of staple cavities 7266 on each side of the slot 7265.

The staple cartridge 7260 includes a stepped deck 7262 having longitudinal steps between adjacent longitudinal portions. More specifically, the staple cartridge 7260 includes a plurality of longitudinal portions 7263 including a first portion, or outer portion, 7263 a and a second portion, or inner portion, 7263 b on each side of a slot 7260. A step 7267 is positioned between the outer portion 7263 a and the inner portion 7263 b. The step 7267 extends parallel to rows 7268 of staple cavities 7266 defined in the deck 7262 and extends along an axis positioned intermediate adjacent rows 7268 of staple cavities 7266.

The step 7267 comprises a height H_(step), which corresponds to the height difference between the first longitudinal portion 7263 a and the second longitudinal portion 7263 b of the deck 7262. Moreover, because the anvil 7001 includes a non-stepped tissue compression surface 7007, the height H_(step) corresponds to the variation in tissue gap between the staple cartridge 7260 and the anvil 7001 when the end effector 7200 is in the closed position. A first tissue gap TG₁ is defined between the first portion 7263 a and the anvil 7001 and a second tissue gap TG₂ is defined between the second portion 7263 b and the anvil 7001. The tissue gap TG₂ is greater than the tissue gap TG₁. It is desirable in certain instances to provide greater tissue compression adjacent to the lateral sides of the end effector 7200 than along a central inner portion of the end effector 7200, as further described herein. In other instances, the staple cartridge 7260 can include additional longitudinal portions having steps therebetween and, in such instances, may define additional, different tissue gaps when the end effector 7200 is in the closed position.

In the fired positions depicted in FIG. 147 , the staples 7280 have been overdriven with respect to the staple cartridge body 7264. More specifically, the staple-supporting surface of each driver 7270 has been driven past the staple cartridge body 7264 such that the staples 7280 are completely removed from the cartridge body 7264 during firing. The cradle, or bottommost surface, of each staple 7280 is positioned above the deck 7262. The cradles of certain staples 7280 are also positioned above the cavity extenders 7261 protruding from the deck 7262 and the cradles of other staples 7280 are positioned below and/or flush with the cavity extenders 7261. The overdrive feature of the drivers 7270 can be configured to fully detach the fired staples 7280 from the staple cartridge 7260 and to facilitate the release of stapled tissue from the end effector 7200.

In various instances, different staples can be overdriven by different amounts. For example, the staples 7280 fired from the outer rows 7268 a of staple cavities 7266 are overdriven a first distance D₁, the staples 7280 fired from the intermediate rows 7268 b of staple cavities 7266 are overdriven a second distance D₂ relative to the cartridge body 7264, and the staples 7280 fired from the inner rows 7268 c of staple cavities 7266 are overdriven a third distance D₃ relative to the cartridge body 7264. The distances D₁, D₂, and D₃ in FIG. 147 are the distances between the cradle of the staples 7280 and the adjacent portion of the deck surface 7262.

To achieve the different overdrive distances D₁, D₂, and D₃ in FIG. 147 , the stroke length of the drivers 7270 can be different. For example, the firing element can be configured to lift the drivers 7270 supporting staples 7280 in the outer rows 7268 a a first distance, to lift the drivers 7070 supporting the staples 7280 in the intermediate row 7268 b a second distance, and to lift the drivers 7270 supporting the staples 7280 in the inner rows 7268 c a third distance. In certain instances, the geometry of the firing element can be selected to control the different stroke lengths of the drivers 7270. Additionally or alternatively, the geometry of the drivers 7270, such as the driver's height, for example, can be selected to control the different overdrive distances. The different overdrive distances D₁, D₂, and D₃ in FIG. 147 can also be controlled by the different heights of the stepped deck 7262.

As described herein with respect to the end effector 7000 (FIG. 145 ), when the tissue gap is constant between rows of staples, different cup depths can be configured to accommodate for variations in overdrive distance such that the staples are formed to the same formed height. For example, referring again to FIG. 147 , the tissue gap TG₁ is constant between the first and second rows 6268 a, 6268 b of staple cavities 6266 and, in such instances, the different cup depths CD₁ and CD₂ are configured to accommodate for the variations in overdrive distances D₁ and D₂. Moreover, as described with respect to the end effector 7100 (FIG. 146 ), when the tissue gap varies between rows of staples, the tissue gap differential can correspond to variations in overdrive distance such that staples are formed to the same formed height. For example, referring again to FIG. 147 , the height H_(step) of the step 7267 corresponds to the difference between the overdrive distances D₂ and D₃.

In various instances, the staple cartridge 7260 can also be compatible with an anvil having a stepped tissue compression surface, such as the anvil 7101 (FIG. 146 ). In such instances, the different overdrive distances D₁, D₂, and D₃ can correspond to different tissue gaps between the anvil's stepped tissue compression surface 7107 and the staple cartridge's stepped deck 7262. An end effector 7300 that includes the staple cartridge 7260 and the anvil 7101 is depicted in FIG. 148 . As further described herein, the end effector 7300 is configured to form staples to a constant formed height across multiple rows.

Owing to the two stepped surfaces 7107 and 7262 in FIG. 148 , the end effector 7300 defines a plurality of tissue gaps between the anvil 7101 and the staple cartridge 7260. A first tissue gap TG₁ is defined between the first portion 7263 a of the deck 7262 and the first portion 7110 a of the tissue compression surface 7107, a second tissue gap TG₂ is defined between the first portion 7263 a of the deck 7262 and the second portion 7110 b of the tissue compression surface 7107, and a third tissue gap TG₃ is defined between the second portion 7263 b of the deck 7262 and the second portion 7110 b of the tissue compression surface 7107. The outer rows 7268 a of staple cavities 7266 and the outer rows 7103 a of staple forming pockets 7102 are aligned with the first tissue gap TG₁, the intermediate rows 7268 b of staple cavities 7266 and the intermediate rows 7103 b of staple forming pockets 7102 are aligned with the second tissue gap TG₂, and the inner rows 7268 c of staple cavities 7266 and the inner rows 7103 c of staple forming pockets 7102 are aligned with the third tissue gap TG₃. As described with respect to the end effector 7100 (FIG. 146 ), when the tissue gap varies between rows of staples, the tissue gap differential can correspond to variations in overdrive distance such that staples are formed to the same formed height. For example, referring again to FIG. 148 , the height H_(step) of the anvil step 7112 corresponds to the difference between the overdrive distances D₁ and D₂ and the height H_(step) of the cartridge step 7267 corresponds to the difference between the overdrive distances D₂ and D₃.

As described herein, a surgical tool assembly can include a shaft portion and an articulatable end effector portion. For example, an articulation assembly can be positioned intermediate the shaft portion and the end effector portion, and the articulation assembly can enable the end effector portion to articulate at an articulation joint relative to the shaft portion. Various articulation assemblies are further described herein and in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 15/019,245, filed Feb. 9, 2016, entitled SURGICAL INSTRUMENTS WITH CLOSURE STROKE REDUCTION ARRANGEMENTS, the entire disclosure of which is hereby incorporated by reference herein.

An exemplary surgical tool assembly 8000 having an articulation joint 8200 is depicted in FIGS. 149-152 . The surgical tool assembly 8000 includes a shaft 8010 and an end effector 8100. The shaft 8010 includes a closure tube assembly 8040 having a distal closure tube insert 8042. The closure tube assembly 8040 is similar in many respects to the closure tube assembly 140 (see, e.g. FIG. 2 ), for example, which is further described herein. The shaft 8010 also includes an articulation drive system 8201 configured to articulate the end effector 8100 relative to the shaft 8010. The articulation joint 8200 is positioned intermediate the shaft 8010 and the end effector 8100 such that articulation motions generated by the articulation drive system 8201 articulate the end effector 8100 about an articulation axis B-B (FIGS. 150-152 ) relative to the shaft 8010.

The articulation drive system 8201 includes an articulation rod 8202 including a distal end 8204. The articulation drive system 8201 also includes an articulation link 8206 comprising a proximal end 8208 coupled to the distal end 8204 of the articulation rod 8202. The articulation rod 8202 extends longitudinally through the shaft portion 8010. In at least one instance, the articulation rod 8202 can be collinear with a central, longitudinal axis L (FIGS. 150-152 ) of the shaft portion 8010 that extends through the articulation axis B-B, although the articulation rod 8202 can be offset from the longitudinal axis L in other embodiments. The distal end 8204 of the articulation rod 8202 includes an extension 8205 extending laterally relative to the central, longitudinal axis L. For example, the extension 8205 extends away from the central, longitudinal axis L. As further described herein, the lateral offset of the extension 8205 relative to the axis L is configured to obtain the desired angular orientation of the articulation link 8206. The articulation rod 8202 is configured to move axially along the central, longitudinal axis L to affect the articulation motions of the end effector 8100. More specifically, displacement of the articulation rod 8202 in the distal direction (DD) is configured to articulate the end effector 8100 clockwise, and displacement of the articulation rod 8202 in the proximal direction (PD) is configured to articulate the end effector 8100 counterclockwise, for example.

The end effector 8100 is articulatable between a first fully articulated configuration and a second fully articulated configuration. The first fully articulated configuration can correspond to the full extent of clockwise rotation, for example, and the second fully articulated configuration can correspond to the full extent of counterclockwise rotation, for example. An unarticulated, or linear, configuration of the end effector 8100 can be positioned intermediate the first fully articulated configuration and the second fully articulated position. In various instances, the unarticulated configuration can be equidistant between the first and second fully articulated configurations. In other instances, based on the geometry of the end effector 8100 and the shaft 8010, a greater degree of articulation can be permitted in one rotational direction. The end effector 8100 can be articulatable through a range of motion comprising at least 120 degrees, for example. In other instances, the end effector 8100 can be configured to articulate through less than 120 degrees. For instance, the end effector 8100 can be configured to articulate about 90 degrees.

The articulation link 8206 is a crosslink, which is similar in certain respects to the crosslink 1237 (FIG. 10 ), for example. The articulation link 8206 is angularly oriented relative to the central, longitudinal axis L. More specifically, the articulation link 8206 traverses the central, longitudinal axis L such that the proximal end 8208 of the articulation link 8206 is positioned on a first side of the central, longitudinal axis L, and a distal end 8210 of the articulation link 8206 is positioned on a second, opposite side of the central, longitudinal axis L. In various instances, the angular orientation of the articulation link 8206 can be configured to improve the mechanical advantage of the articulation drive system 8201. As the articulation rod 8202 moves axially relative to the central, longitudinal axis L, the articulation link 8206 is also displaced relative to the central, longitudinal axis L. For example, referring to FIGS. 150-152 , as the articulation joint 8200 is moved from an unarticulated configuration (FIG. 150 ) to a first articulated configuration (FIG. 151 ) and to a second articulated configuration (FIG. 152 ), the articulation rod 8202 and the articulation link 8206 are displaced distally. As further described herein, the first articulated configuration corresponds to a partially articulated configuration and the second articulated configuration corresponds to a fully articulated configuration of the surgical tool assembly 8000.

In certain instances, the articulation drive system 8201 may not include the articulation link 8206. For example, the articulation rod 8202 can be pivotably coupled to the end effector 8100. In certain instances, the distal end portion of the articulation rod 8202 can define a contour and/or offset such that the distal end of the articulation rod 8202 is laterally offset from the proximal end and/or from the central, longitudinal axis L.

Referring still to FIGS. 149-152 , the distal end 8210 of the articulation link 8206 is pivotably coupled to the end effector portion 8100 of the surgical tool assembly 8000 at a pivot joint 8211. For example, the distal end 8210 is coupled to a proximal portion, or extension, 8103 of the end effector's elongate channel or retainer portion 8102 at a pivot axis A-A (FIGS. 150-152 ) through the pivot joint 8211. Owing to the orientation of the articulation link 8206, the pivot axis A-A is laterally offset from the central, longitudinal axis L and from the articulation axis B-B. The distal end 8210 of the articulation link 8206 is coupled to the proximal extension 8103 such that the pivot axis A-A extends through the proximal extension 8103.

As the articulation rod 8202 and the articulation link 8206 are moved, e.g. pushed, in the distal direction (DD), the elongate channel 8102 is pivoted in the clockwise direction at the pivot axis A-A. In various instances, the end effector 8100 can encounter resistance to the articulation thereof and the articulation link 8206 can be subjected to a compressive load as the articulation drive system 8201 seeks to overcome the resistance. In certain instances, when exposed to a load above a threshold load, the articulation bar 8202 and/or the articulation link 8206 may be prone to bending, buckling, and/or backing up from the desired articulated position. Stated another way, the articulation link 8206 can be susceptible to lateral bowing under increased compressive loads. To counter or resist bowing and/or de-articulation of the compressed articulation bar 8202 and/or articulation link 8206 under high compressive loads, the articulation system 8201 can include a reinforcement or anti-backup feature.

A reinforcement feature 8220 is depicted in FIGS. 149-152 . The reinforcement feature 8220 includes a brace 8106 on the end effector 8100, which is operably configured to engage a recess or notch 8226 in the articulation link 8206 in certain instances. The brace 8106 is disengaged from the recess 8226 during the majority of the articulation motion (see FIGS. 149-151 ); however, in the fully articulated configuration of FIG. 152 , the brace 8106 is received within the recess or pocket 8226, and portions of the brace 8106 are in abutting contact with the sidewalls of the recess 8226. The brace 8106 comprises a post that protrudes from the proximal end of the elongate channel 8102 and the recess 8226 defines a pocket that is aligned with the brace 8106 such that the brace 8226 moves into the pocket when the end effector 8100 is articulated into its fully articulated configuration (FIG. 152 ). In such instances, the brace 8106 provides a stopping surface that prevents further clockwise articulation of the end effector 8100 beyond the fully articulated configuration.

Moreover, in the fully articulated configuration of FIG. 152 , the brace 8106 is configured to exert a counter-bowing and anti-backup force on the articulation link 8206. More specifically, when a force is applied to the end effector 8100, such as an externally-applied force opposing the articulation motion of the articulation drive system 8201, the more engagement between the recess 8226 and the brace 8106 is configured to resist de-articulation and/or bowing of the articulation link 8206. For example, the recess 8226 can apply a resistive, anti-backup force to the brace 8016 in response to a de-articulation force being applied to the fully articulated end effector 8100.

In various instances, the reinforcement feature 8220 can include at least one pair of opposing planar surfaces or “flats” to transfer forces between the brace 8106 and the recess 8226. For example, the recess 8226 can define an inner surface having at least one flat or planar surface and the brace 8106 can define an outer surface having at least one flat or planar surface. The planar surface(s) can be complementary such that they are positioned in abutting contact when the end effector 8100 is in the fully articulated configuration. For example, the recess 8226 can fit around portions of the brace 8106 like a wrench fits on the head of a bolt. Abutting planar surfaces are configured to provide force-transfer surfaces for the reinforcement feature 8220 and counter rotation of the brace 8106 within the recess 8226. The brace 8106 and the recess 8226 have asymmetric profiles. However, the brace 8106 and the recess 8226 can have symmetric outer profiles in other instances.

Referring primarily to FIG. 152A, a detail view of the reinforcement feature 8220 of FIG. 152 is depicted. The recess 8226 includes an inner surface 8228 having a plurality of planar surface 8230 a, 8230 b, 8230 c. Moreover, the brace 8106 includes an outer surface 8108 having a plurality of complementary planar surfaces 8110 a, 8110 b, 8210 b. The planar surface(s) 8230 a, 8230 b of the recess 8226 can abut the corresponding planar surface(s) 8210 a, 8210 b of the brace 8226 to hold the brace 8106 within the recess 8226. Moreover, when the brace 8106 is received within the recess 8226, the planar surfaces can be oriented to resist de-articulation and/or and exert counter-bowing forces on the articulation link 8206. In various instances, the inner surface 8228 of the recess 8226 and the outer surface 8108 of the brace 8106 can also include contoured and/or rounded surfaces adjacent to and/or intermediate the planar surfaces.

In various instances, the articulation system 8201 can include a plurality of reinforcement features 8220. For example, the articulation system 8201 can include a recess similar to the recess 8226 toward the proximal end 8208 of the articulation link 8206. Such a recess can be configured to engage a grounding feature on the end effector 8100 and/or provide a positive stopping surface when the end effector 8100 is fully articulated in a counterclockwise direction, for example.

Many of the surgical instrument systems described herein are motivated by an electric motor; however, the surgical instrument systems described herein can be motivated in any suitable manner. In various instances, the surgical instrument systems described herein can be motivated by a manually-operated trigger, for example. In certain instances, the motors disclosed herein may comprise a portion or portions of a robotically controlled system. Moreover, any of the end effectors and/or tool assemblies disclosed herein can be utilized with a robotic surgical instrument system. U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/118,241, entitled SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENTS WITH ROTATABLE STAPLE DEPLOYMENT ARRANGEMENTS, now U.S. Pat. No. 9,072,535, for example, discloses several examples of a robotic surgical instrument system in greater detail.

The surgical instrument systems described herein have been described in connection with the deployment and deformation of staples; however, the embodiments described herein are not so limited. Various embodiments are envisioned which deploy fasteners other than staples, such as clamps or tacks, for example. Moreover, various embodiments are envisioned which utilize any suitable means for sealing tissue. For instance, an end effector in accordance with various embodiments can comprise electrodes configured to heat and seal the tissue. Also, for instance, an end effector in accordance with certain embodiments can apply vibrational energy to seal the tissue.

The entire disclosures of:

-   -   U.S. Pat. No. 5,403,312, entitled ELECTROSURGICAL HEMOSTATIC         DEVICE, which issued on Apr. 4, 1995;     -   U.S. Pat. No. 7,000,818, entitled SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENT         HAVING SEPARATE DISTINCT CLOSING AND FIRING SYSTEMS, which         issued on Feb. 21, 2006;     -   U.S. Pat. No. 7,422,139, entitled MOTOR-DRIVEN SURGICAL CUTTING         AND FASTENING INSTRUMENT WITH TACTILE POSITION FEEDBACK, which         issued on Sep. 9, 2008;     -   U.S. Pat. No. 7,464,849, entitled ELECTRO-MECHANICAL SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT WITH CLOSURE SYSTEM AND ANVIL ALIGNMENT COMPONENTS,         which issued on Dec. 16, 2008;     -   U.S. Pat. No. 7,670,334, entitled SURGICAL INSTRUMENT HAVING AN         ARTICULATING END EFFECTOR, which issued on Mar. 2, 2010;     -   U.S. Pat. No. 7,753,245, entitled SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENTS,         which issued on Jul. 13, 2010;     -   U.S. Pat. No. 8,393,514, entitled SELECTIVELY ORIENTABLE         IMPLANTABLE FASTENER CARTRIDGE, which issued on Mar. 12, 2013;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/343,803, entitled SURGICAL         INSTRUMENT HAVING RECORDING CAPABILITIES; now U.S. Pat. No.         7,845,537;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/031,573, entitled SURGICAL         CUTTING AND FASTENING INSTRUMENT HAVING RF ELECTRODES, filed         Feb. 14, 2008;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/031,873, entitled END         EFFECTORS FOR A SURGICAL CUTTING AND STAPLING INSTRUMENT, filed         Feb. 15, 2008, now U.S. Pat. No. 7,980,443;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/235,782, entitled         MOTOR-DRIVEN SURGICAL CUTTING INSTRUMENT, now U.S. Pat. No.         8,210,411;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/249,117, entitled POWERED         SURGICAL CUTTING AND STAPLING APPARATUS WITH MANUALLY         RETRACTABLE FIRING SYSTEM, now U.S. Pat. No. 8,608,045;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/647,100, entitled         MOTOR-DRIVEN SURGICAL CUTTING INSTRUMENT WITH ELECTRIC ACTUATOR         DIRECTIONAL CONTROL ASSEMBLY, filed Dec. 24, 2009; now U.S. Pat.         No. 8,220,688;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/893,461, entitled STAPLE         CARTRIDGE, filed Sep. 29, 2012, now U.S. Pat. No. 8,733,613;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/036,647, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING INSTRUMENT, filed Feb. 28, 2011, now U.S. Pat. No.         8,561,870;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/118,241, entitled SURGICAL         STAPLING INSTRUMENTS WITH ROTATABLE STAPLE DEPLOYMENT         ARRANGEMENTS, now U.S. Pat. No. 9,072,535;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/524,049, entitled         ARTICULATABLE SURGICAL INSTRUMENT COMPRISING A FIRING DRIVE,         filed on Jun. 15, 2012; now U.S. Pat. No. 9,101,358;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/800,025, entitled STAPLE         CARTRIDGE TISSUE THICKNESS SENSOR SYSTEM, filed on Mar. 13,         2013, now U.S. Pat. No. 9,345,481;     -   U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/800,067, entitled STAPLE         CARTRIDGE TISSUE THICKNESS SENSOR SYSTEM, filed on Mar. 13,         2013, now U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2014/0263552;     -   U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2007/0175955, entitled         SURGICAL CUTTING AND FASTENING INSTRUMENT WITH CLOSURE TRIGGER         LOCKING MECHANISM, filed Jan. 31, 2006; and     -   U.S. Patent Application Publication No. 2010/0264194, entitled         SURGICAL STAPLING INSTRUMENT WITH AN ARTICULATABLE END EFFECTOR,         filed Apr. 22, 2010, now U.S. Pat. No. 8,308,040, are hereby         incorporated by reference herein.

Although various devices have been described herein in connection with certain embodiments, modifications and variations to those embodiments may be implemented. Particular features, structures, or characteristics may be combined in any suitable manner in one or more embodiments. Thus, the particular features, structures, or characteristics illustrated or described in connection with one embodiment may be combined in whole or in part, with the features, structures or characteristics of one ore more other embodiments without limitation. Also, where materials are disclosed for certain components, other materials may be used. Furthermore, according to various embodiments, a single component may be replaced by multiple components, and multiple components may be replaced by a single component, to perform a given function or functions. The foregoing description and following claims are intended to cover all such modification and variations.

The devices disclosed herein can be designed to be disposed of after a single use, or they can be designed to be used multiple times. In either case, however, a device can be reconditioned for reuse after at least one use. Reconditioning can include any combination of the steps including, but not limited to, the disassembly of the device, followed by cleaning or replacement of particular pieces of the device, and subsequent reassembly of the device. In particular, a reconditioning facility and/or surgical team can disassemble a device and, after cleaning and/or replacing particular parts of the device, the device can be reassembled for subsequent use. Those skilled in the art will appreciate that reconditioning of a device can utilize a variety of techniques for disassembly, cleaning/replacement, and reassembly. Use of such techniques, and the resulting reconditioned device, are all within the scope of the present application.

The devices disclosed herein may be processed before surgery. First, a new or used instrument may be obtained and, when necessary, cleaned. The instrument may then be sterilized. In one sterilization technique, the instrument is placed in a closed and sealed container, such as a plastic or TYVEK bag. The container and instrument may then be placed in a field of radiation that can penetrate the container, such as gamma radiation, x-rays, and/or high-energy electrons. The radiation may kill bacteria on the instrument and in the container. The sterilized instrument may then be stored in the sterile container. The sealed container may keep the instrument sterile until it is opened in a medical facility. A device may also be sterilized using any other technique known in the art, including but not limited to beta radiation, gamma radiation, ethylene oxide, plasma peroxide, and/or steam.

While this invention has been described as having exemplary designs, the present invention may be further modified within the spirit and scope of the disclosure. This application is therefore intended to cover any variations, uses, or adaptations of the invention using its general principles.

Any patent, publication, or other disclosure material, in whole or in part, that is said to be incorporated by reference herein is incorporated herein only to the extent that the incorporated materials do not conflict with existing definitions, statements, or other disclosure material set forth in this disclosure. As such, and to the extent necessary, the disclosure as explicitly set forth herein supersedes any conflicting material incorporated herein by reference. Any material, or portion thereof, that is said to be incorporated by reference herein, but which conflicts with existing definitions, statements, or other disclosure material set forth herein will only be incorporated to the extent that no conflict arises between that incorporated material and the existing disclosure material. 

1-20. (canceled)
 21. An end effector comprising: a staple cartridge comprising a plurality of staples removably stored in said staple cartridge; an anvil comprising: a proximal anvil portion; a first stiffness based at least in part on the proximal anvil portion; and a forming surface comprising a plurality of staple forming pockets defined in the forming surface, wherein the staple forming pockets are confirmed to deform the staples ejected from the staple cartridge; a staple cartridge channel configured to receive the staple cartridge therein, wherein the staple cartridge channel comprises: a proximal cutout portion; and a second stiffness based at least in part on the proximal cutout portion; and a firing member configured to control a tissue gap distance between the anvil and the staple cartridge during a staple firing stroke, wherein in a closed configuration of the end effector the proximal anvil portion occupies a void defined by the proximal cutout portion.
 22. The end effector of claim 21, wherein the first stiffness and the second stiffness comprise a ratio of between 1:3 and 1:1.
 23. The end effector of claim 21, wherein the first stiffness is increased by increasing a size of the proximal anvil portion and increasing a size of the proximal cutout portion.
 24. The end effector of claim 21, wherein the staple cartridge channel further comprises channel walls comprising: a proximal zone comprising a first width; and a distal zone comprising a second width, wherein the second width is greater than the first width, and wherein in the closed configuration the proximal anvil portion surrounds the channel walls in the proximal zone.
 25. The end effector of claim 24, wherein in the closed configuration the anvil and the staple cartridge channel define a clamped diameter, and wherein the proximal cutout portion is defined as a space beyond the first width but within the clamped diameter.
 26. The end effector of claim 24, wherein the proximal anvil portion comprises a first ledge, wherein the channel walls in the proximal zone comprise a second ledge, and wherein the second ledge is configured to face the first ledge when the end effector is in the closed configuration.
 27. The end effector of claim 21, wherein in the closed configuration the proximal anvil portion surrounds the proximal cutout portion.
 28. An end effector comprising: an anvil jaw comprising: a first stiffness; and a proximal surrounding portion; and a staple cartridge jaw configured to receive a staple cartridge therein, the staple cartridge jaw comprising: a second stiffness; and channel walls comprising a proximal zone, wherein the end effector is configured to move from an open configuration to a closed configuration, and wherein in the closed configuration the proximal surrounding portion abuts the channel walls in the proximal zone.
 29. The end effector of claim 28, wherein the first stiffness and the second stiffness comprise a ratio of between 1:3 and 1:1.
 30. The end effector of claim 28, wherein the first stiffness is increased by adding material to the anvil jaw and removing material from the staple cartridge jaw.
 31. The end effector of claim 28, wherein the proximal zone comprises a first width, wherein the channel walls further comprise a distal zone comprising a second width, and wherein the second width is greater than the first width.
 32. The end effector of claim 31, wherein in the closed configuration the anvil jaw and the staple cartridge jaw define a clamped diameter, wherein the proximal surrounding portion comprises a volume of material, and wherein in the closed configuration the volume of material is configured to occupy a void defined as a space beyond the first width but within the clamped diameter.
 33. The end effector of claim 28, wherein the proximal surrounding portion comprises a first ledge, wherein the channel walls in the proximal zone comprise a second ledge, and wherein in the closed configuration the second ledge is configured to face the first ledge.
 34. The end effector of claim 28, wherein the channel walls comprises a proximal cutout portion, wherein in the closed configuration the proximal surrounding portion is configured to surround the proximal cutout portion.
 35. The end effector of claim 34, wherein the end effector further comprises a clamped diameter, wherein the proximal surrounding portion comprises a volume of material configured to occupy a void defined by the proximal cutout portion.
 36. An end effector for use with a surgical device, the end effector comprising: an anvil comprising: a protrusion; and a first stiffness based at least in part on the protrusion; and a staple cartridge channel configured to receive a staple cartridge therein, the staple cartridge channel comprising: channel walls comprising a proximal portion that defines a cutout portion; and a second stiffness based at least in part on the cutout portion, wherein the end effector is configured to move from an open configuration to a closed configuration, and wherein in the closed configuration the protrusion occupies a void defined by the cutout portion.
 37. The end effector of claim 36, wherein the first stiffness and the second stiffness comprise a ratio of between 1:3 and 1:1.
 38. The end effector of claim 36, wherein in the closed configuration the protrusion abuts the proximal portion.
 39. The surgical device of claim 36, wherein the first stiffness is increased by increasing a size of the protrusion and increasing a size of the cutout portion.
 40. The end effector of claim 36, wherein the proximal portion comprises a first width, wherein the channel walls further comprise a distal portion comprising a second width, and wherein the second width is greater than the first width. 